PowerPC64 synthetic symbols
[binutils-gdb.git] / ld / ld.texi
1 \input texinfo
2 @setfilename ld.info
3 @c Copyright (C) 1991-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 @syncodeindex ky cp
5 @c man begin INCLUDE
6 @include configdoc.texi
7 @c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile)
8 @include bfdver.texi
9 @c man end
10
11 @c @smallbook
12
13 @macro gcctabopt{body}
14 @code{\body\}
15 @end macro
16
17 @c man begin NAME
18 @ifset man
19 @c Configure for the generation of man pages
20 @set UsesEnvVars
21 @set GENERIC
22 @set ARM
23 @set C6X
24 @set CSKY
25 @set H8300
26 @set HPPA
27 @set M68HC11
28 @set M68K
29 @set MIPS
30 @set MMIX
31 @set MSP430
32 @set NDS32
33 @set NIOSII
34 @set PDP11
35 @set POWERPC
36 @set POWERPC64
37 @set Renesas
38 @set S/390
39 @set SPU
40 @set TICOFF
41 @set WIN32
42 @set XTENSA
43 @end ifset
44 @c man end
45
46 @ifnottex
47 @dircategory Software development
48 @direntry
49 * Ld: (ld). The GNU linker.
50 @end direntry
51 @end ifnottex
52
53 @copying
54 This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD
55 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
56 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
57 @end ifset
58 version @value{VERSION}.
59
60 Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
61
62 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
63 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
64 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
65 with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
66 Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
67 section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
68 @end copying
69 @iftex
70 @finalout
71 @setchapternewpage odd
72 @settitle The GNU linker
73 @titlepage
74 @title The GNU linker
75 @sp 1
76 @subtitle @code{ld}
77 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
78 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
79 @end ifset
80 @subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
81 @author Steve Chamberlain
82 @author Ian Lance Taylor
83 @page
84
85 @tex
86 {\parskip=0pt
87 \hfill Red Hat Inc\par
88 \hfill nickc\@credhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par
89 \hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par
90 \hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par
91 }
92 \global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way.
93 @end tex
94
95 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
96 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
97 Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
98
99 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
100 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
101 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
102 with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
103 Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
104 section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
105 @c man end
106
107 @end titlepage
108 @end iftex
109 @contents
110 @c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker!
111
112 @ifnottex
113 @node Top
114 @top LD
115 This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld
116 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
117 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
118 @end ifset
119 version @value{VERSION}.
120
121 This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
122 Documentation License version 1.3. A copy of the license is included
123 in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
124
125 @menu
126 * Overview:: Overview
127 * Invocation:: Invocation
128 * Scripts:: Linker Scripts
129 * Plugins:: Linker Plugins
130 @ifset GENERIC
131 * Machine Dependent:: Machine Dependent Features
132 @end ifset
133 @ifclear GENERIC
134 @ifset H8300
135 * H8/300:: ld and the H8/300
136 @end ifset
137 @ifset Renesas
138 * Renesas:: ld and other Renesas micros
139 @end ifset
140 @ifset ARM
141 * ARM:: ld and the ARM family
142 @end ifset
143 @ifset M68HC11
144 * M68HC11/68HC12:: ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
145 @end ifset
146 @ifset HPPA
147 * HPPA ELF32:: ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF
148 @end ifset
149 @ifset M68K
150 * M68K:: ld and Motorola 68K family
151 @end ifset
152 @ifset MIPS
153 * MIPS:: ld and MIPS family
154 @end ifset
155 @ifset POWERPC
156 * PowerPC ELF32:: ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
157 @end ifset
158 @ifset POWERPC64
159 * PowerPC64 ELF64:: ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
160 @end ifset
161 @ifset S/390
162 * S/390 ELF:: ld and S/390 ELF Support
163 @end ifset
164 @ifset SPU
165 * SPU ELF:: ld and SPU ELF Support
166 @end ifset
167 @ifset TICOFF
168 * TI COFF:: ld and the TI COFF
169 @end ifset
170 @ifset WIN32
171 * Win32:: ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
172 @end ifset
173 @ifset XTENSA
174 * Xtensa:: ld and Xtensa Processors
175 @end ifset
176 @end ifclear
177 @ifclear SingleFormat
178 * BFD:: BFD
179 @end ifclear
180 @c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus
181
182 * Reporting Bugs:: Reporting Bugs
183 * MRI:: MRI Compatible Script Files
184 * GNU Free Documentation License:: GNU Free Documentation License
185 * LD Index:: LD Index
186 @end menu
187 @end ifnottex
188
189 @node Overview
190 @chapter Overview
191
192 @cindex @sc{gnu} linker
193 @cindex what is this?
194
195 @ifset man
196 @c man begin SYNOPSIS
197 ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{}
198 @c man end
199
200 @c man begin SEEALSO
201 ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and
202 the Info entries for @file{binutils} and
203 @file{ld}.
204 @c man end
205 @end ifset
206
207 @c man begin DESCRIPTION
208
209 @command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates
210 their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in
211 compiling a program is to run @command{ld}.
212
213 @command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in
214 a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax,
215 to provide explicit and total control over the linking process.
216
217 @ifset man
218 @c For the man only
219 This man page does not describe the command language; see the
220 @command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command
221 language and on other aspects of the GNU linker.
222 @end ifset
223
224 @ifclear SingleFormat
225 This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries
226 to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and
227 write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or
228 @code{a.out}. Different formats may be linked together to produce any
229 available kind of object file. @xref{BFD}, for more information.
230 @end ifclear
231
232 Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other
233 linkers in providing diagnostic information. Many linkers abandon
234 execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
235 @command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors
236 (or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
237
238 @c man end
239
240 @node Invocation
241 @chapter Invocation
242
243 @c man begin DESCRIPTION
244
245 The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations,
246 and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers. As a result,
247 you have many choices to control its behavior.
248
249 @c man end
250
251 @ifset UsesEnvVars
252 @menu
253 * Options:: Command-line Options
254 * Environment:: Environment Variables
255 @end menu
256
257 @node Options
258 @section Command-line Options
259 @end ifset
260
261 @cindex command line
262 @cindex options
263
264 @c man begin OPTIONS
265
266 The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
267 practice few of them are used in any particular context.
268 @cindex standard Unix system
269 For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix
270 object files on a standard, supported Unix system. On such a system, to
271 link a file @code{hello.o}:
272
273 @smallexample
274 ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
275 @end smallexample
276
277 This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the
278 result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and
279 the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search
280 directories. (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.)
281
282 Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any
283 point in the command line. However, options which refer to files, such
284 as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at
285 which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object
286 files and other file options. Repeating non-file options with a
287 different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
288 occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
289 option. Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
290 noted in the descriptions below.
291
292 @cindex object files
293 Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked
294 together. They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line
295 options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between
296 an option and its argument.
297
298 Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can
299 specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R},
300 and the script command language. If @emph{no} binary input files at all
301 are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
302 message @samp{No input files}.
303
304 If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
305 assume that it is a linker script. A script specified in this way
306 augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
307 linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}). This feature
308 permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
309 or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
310 @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects. Specifying a
311 script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the
312 extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option
313 to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of
314 the @code{INSERT} command. @xref{Scripts}.
315
316 For options whose names are a single letter,
317 option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening
318 whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the
319 option that requires them.
320
321 For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can
322 precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and
323 @samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent. Note---there is one exception to
324 this rule. Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
325 only be preceded by two dashes. This is to reduce confusion with the
326 @samp{-o} option. So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file
327 name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the
328 output.
329
330 Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the
331 option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
332 immediately following the option that requires them. For example,
333 @samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent.
334 Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are
335 accepted.
336
337 Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver
338 (e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be
339 prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
340 compiler driver) like this:
341
342 @smallexample
343 gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
344 @end smallexample
345
346 This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
347 silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link. Confusion
348 may also arise when passing options that require values through a
349 driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as
350 a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
351 and the argument to the compiler. In this case, it is simplest to use
352 the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
353
354 @smallexample
355 gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
356 @end smallexample
357
358 Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU
359 linker:
360
361 @table @gcctabopt
362 @include at-file.texi
363
364 @kindex -a @var{keyword}
365 @item -a @var{keyword}
366 This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility. The @var{keyword}
367 argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or
368 @samp{default}. @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to
369 @samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent
370 to @samp{-Bdynamic}. This option may be used any number of times.
371
372 @kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
373 @item --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
374 Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
375 @var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
376 specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT}
377 will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker
378 finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries,
379 it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file.
380 This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit
381 interface.
382
383 @ifclear SingleFormat
384 @cindex binary input format
385 @kindex -b @var{format}
386 @kindex --format=@var{format}
387 @cindex input format
388 @cindex input format
389 @item -b @var{input-format}
390 @itemx --format=@var{input-format}
391 @command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
392 file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
393 @samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files
394 that follow this option on the command line. Even when @command{ld} is
395 configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need
396 to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a
397 default input format the most usual format on each machine.
398 @var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format
399 supported by the BFD libraries. (You can list the available binary
400 formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)
401 @xref{BFD}.
402
403 You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual
404 binary format. You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when
405 linking object files of different formats), by including
406 @samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a
407 particular format.
408
409 The default format is taken from the environment variable
410 @code{GNUTARGET}.
411 @ifset UsesEnvVars
412 @xref{Environment}.
413 @end ifset
414 You can also define the input format from a script, using the command
415 @code{TARGET};
416 @ifclear man
417 see @ref{Format Commands}.
418 @end ifclear
419 @end ifclear
420
421 @kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile}
422 @kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile}
423 @cindex compatibility, MRI
424 @item -c @var{MRI-commandfile}
425 @itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile}
426 For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script
427 files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in
428 @ifclear man
429 @ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}.
430 @end ifclear
431 @ifset man
432 the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation.
433 @end ifset
434 Introduce MRI script files with
435 the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker
436 scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language.
437 If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories
438 specified by any @samp{-L} options.
439
440 @cindex common allocation
441 @kindex -d
442 @kindex -dc
443 @kindex -dp
444 @item -d
445 @itemx -dc
446 @itemx -dp
447 These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for
448 compatibility with other linkers. They assign space to common symbols
449 even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}). The
450 script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
451 @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
452
453 @kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
454 @kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB}
455 @item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
456 @itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB}
457 Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
458 @var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
459 specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT}
460 will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. This
461 option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
462 The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility.
463
464 @kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions
465 @item --enable-non-contiguous-regions
466 This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not
467 fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input
468 section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an
469 error only if no output section is large enough. This is useful when
470 several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input
471 section does not require a particular one. The order in which input
472 sections are evaluated does not change, for instance:
473
474 @smallexample
475 MEMORY @{
476 MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14
477 MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40
478 MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40
479 @}
480 SECTIONS @{
481 mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1
482 mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
483 mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
484 @}
485
486 with input sections:
487 .data.1: size 8
488 .data.2: size 0x10
489 .data.3: size 4
490
491 results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3
492 affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3.
493 @end smallexample
494
495 This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes
496 the way input sections are mapped to output sections.
497
498 @kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
499 @item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
500 This option enables warnings when
501 @code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected
502 matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently
503 discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any
504 output region.
505
506 @cindex entry point, from command line
507 @kindex -e @var{entry}
508 @kindex --entry=@var{entry}
509 @item -e @var{entry}
510 @itemx --entry=@var{entry}
511 Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
512 program, rather than the default entry point. If there is no symbol
513 named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number,
514 and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in
515 base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading
516 @samp{0} for base 8). @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults
517 and other ways of specifying the entry point.
518
519 @kindex --exclude-libs
520 @item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},...
521 Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically
522 exported. The library names may be delimited by commas or colons. Specifying
523 @code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from
524 automatic export. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted
525 port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports. For i386 PE, symbols
526 explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this
527 option. For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will
528 be treated as hidden.
529
530 @kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib
531 @item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},...
532 Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols
533 should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale
534 into the import library being generated during the link. The module names
535 may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames
536 used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply
537 the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and
538 match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
539 command-line. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port
540 of the linker. Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported,
541 regardless of this option.
542
543 @cindex dynamic symbol table
544 @kindex -E
545 @kindex --export-dynamic
546 @kindex --no-export-dynamic
547 @item -E
548 @itemx --export-dynamic
549 @itemx --no-export-dynamic
550 When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E}
551 option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add
552 all symbols to the dynamic symbol table. The dynamic symbol table is the
553 set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time.
554
555 If you do not use either of these options (or use the
556 @option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the
557 dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are
558 referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
559
560 If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
561 back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
562 dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
563 linking the program itself.
564
565 You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
566 be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it.
567 See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}.
568
569 Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports. PE targets
570 support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see
571 the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below.
572
573 @kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
574 @cindex export dynamic symbol
575 @item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
576 When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching
577 @var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a
578 shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be
579 bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a
580 no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or
581 @samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful
582 on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
583
584 @kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
585 @cindex export dynamic symbol list
586 @item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
587 Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file.
588 The format of the file is the same as the version node without
589 scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
590
591 @ifclear SingleFormat
592 @cindex big-endian objects
593 @cindex endianness
594 @kindex -EB
595 @item -EB
596 Link big-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
597
598 @cindex little-endian objects
599 @kindex -EL
600 @item -EL
601 Link little-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
602 @end ifclear
603
604 @kindex -f @var{name}
605 @kindex --auxiliary=@var{name}
606 @item -f @var{name}
607 @itemx --auxiliary=@var{name}
608 When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field
609 to the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol
610 table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the
611 symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
612
613 If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
614 run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field. If
615 the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will
616 first check whether there is a definition in the shared object
617 @var{name}. If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition
618 in the filter object. The shared object @var{name} need not exist.
619 Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative
620 implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for
621 machine-specific performance.
622
623 This option may be specified more than once. The DT_AUXILIARY entries
624 will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line.
625
626 @kindex -F @var{name}
627 @kindex --filter=@var{name}
628 @item -F @var{name}
629 @itemx --filter=@var{name}
630 When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to
631 the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table
632 of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter
633 on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
634
635 If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
636 run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field. The
637 dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the
638 filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions
639 found in the shared object @var{name}. Thus the filter object can be
640 used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object
641 @var{name}.
642
643 Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation
644 toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output
645 object files.
646 @ifclear SingleFormat
647 The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the
648 @option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the
649 @code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET}
650 environment variable.
651 @end ifclear
652 The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not
653 creating an ELF shared object.
654
655 @cindex finalization function
656 @kindex -fini=@var{name}
657 @item -fini=@var{name}
658 When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
659 executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the
660 address of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as
661 the function to call.
662
663 @kindex -g
664 @item -g
665 Ignored. Provided for compatibility with other tools.
666
667 @kindex -G @var{value}
668 @kindex --gpsize=@var{value}
669 @cindex object size
670 @item -G @var{value}
671 @itemx --gpsize=@var{value}
672 Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to
673 @var{size}. This is only meaningful for object file formats such as
674 MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different
675 sections. This is ignored for other object file formats.
676
677 @cindex runtime library name
678 @kindex -h @var{name}
679 @kindex -soname=@var{name}
680 @item -h @var{name}
681 @itemx -soname=@var{name}
682 When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to
683 the specified name. When an executable is linked with a shared object
684 which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic
685 linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME
686 field rather than the using the file name given to the linker.
687
688 @kindex -i
689 @cindex incremental link
690 @item -i
691 Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}).
692
693 @cindex initialization function
694 @kindex -init=@var{name}
695 @item -init=@var{name}
696 When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
697 executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address
698 of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the
699 function to call.
700
701 @cindex archive files, from cmd line
702 @kindex -l @var{namespec}
703 @kindex --library=@var{namespec}
704 @item -l @var{namespec}
705 @itemx --library=@var{namespec}
706 Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the
707 list of files to link. This option may be used any number of times.
708 If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld}
709 will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it
710 will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.
711
712 On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for
713 files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. Specifically, on ELF
714 and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library
715 called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called
716 @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. (By convention, a @code{.so} extension
717 indicates a shared library.) Note that this behavior does not apply
718 to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called
719 @var{filename}.
720
721 The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is
722 specified on the command line. If the archive defines a symbol which
723 was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the
724 command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the
725 archive. However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on
726 the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again.
727
728 See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search
729 archives multiple times.
730
731 You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
732
733 @ifset GENERIC
734 This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers. However,
735 if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the
736 behaviour of the AIX linker.
737 @end ifset
738
739 @cindex search directory, from cmd line
740 @kindex -L @var{dir}
741 @kindex --library-path=@var{dir}
742 @item -L @var{searchdir}
743 @itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir}
744 Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search
745 for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts. You may use this
746 option any number of times. The directories are searched in the order
747 in which they are specified on the command line. Directories specified
748 on the command line are searched before the default directories. All
749 @option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the
750 order in which the options appear. @option{-L} options do not affect
751 how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T}
752 option is specified.
753
754 If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this
755 prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the
756 @samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured.
757
758 @ifset UsesEnvVars
759 The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
760 @samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in
761 some cases also on how it was configured. @xref{Environment}.
762 @end ifset
763
764 The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
765 @code{SEARCH_DIR} command. Directories specified this way are searched
766 at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line.
767
768 @cindex emulation
769 @kindex -m @var{emulation}
770 @item -m @var{emulation}
771 Emulate the @var{emulation} linker. You can list the available
772 emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.
773
774 If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
775 @code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined.
776
777 Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
778 configured.
779
780 @cindex link map
781 @kindex -M
782 @kindex --print-map
783 @item -M
784 @itemx --print-map
785 Print a link map to the standard output. A link map provides
786 information about the link, including the following:
787
788 @itemize @bullet
789 @item
790 Where object files are mapped into memory.
791 @item
792 How common symbols are allocated.
793 @item
794 All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol
795 which caused the archive member to be brought in.
796 @item
797 The values assigned to symbols.
798
799 Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which
800 involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not
801 have correct result displayed in the link map. This is because the
802 linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value
803 of an expression. Under such circumstances the linker will display
804 the final value enclosed by square brackets. Thus for example a
805 linker script containing:
806
807 @smallexample
808 foo = 1
809 foo = foo * 4
810 foo = foo + 8
811 @end smallexample
812
813 will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M}
814 option is used:
815
816 @smallexample
817 0x00000001 foo = 0x1
818 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo * 0x4)
819 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo + 0x8)
820 @end smallexample
821
822 See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker
823 scripts.
824
825 @item
826 How GNU properties are merged.
827
828 When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output
829 .note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated.
830 These actions are reported in the link map. For example:
831
832 @smallexample
833 Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found)
834 @end smallexample
835
836 This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when
837 merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value
838 is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002.
839
840 @smallexample
841 Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1)
842 @end smallexample
843
844 This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output
845 when merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value
846 is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1.
847 @end itemize
848
849 @cindex link map discarded
850 @kindex --print-map-discarded
851 @kindex --no-print-map-discarded
852 @item --print-map-discarded
853 @itemx --no-print-map-discarded
854 Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections
855 in the link map. Enabled by default.
856
857 @kindex -n
858 @cindex read-only text
859 @cindex NMAGIC
860 @kindex --nmagic
861 @item -n
862 @itemx --nmagic
863 Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared
864 libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
865 mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}.
866
867 @kindex -N
868 @kindex --omagic
869 @cindex read/write from cmd line
870 @cindex OMAGIC
871 @item -N
872 @itemx --omagic
873 Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable. Also, do
874 not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared
875 libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
876 mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section
877 is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format
878 specification published by Microsoft.
879
880 @kindex --no-omagic
881 @cindex OMAGIC
882 @item --no-omagic
883 This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option. It
884 sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to
885 be page-aligned. Note - this option does not enable linking against
886 shared libraries. Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this.
887
888 @kindex -o @var{output}
889 @kindex --output=@var{output}
890 @cindex naming the output file
891 @item -o @var{output}
892 @itemx --output=@var{output}
893 Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this
894 option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default. The
895 script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name.
896
897 @kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
898 @cindex dependency file
899 @item --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
900 Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}. This file contains a rule
901 suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files
902 that were read to produce it. The output is similar to the compiler's
903 output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options
904 Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler
905 Collection}). Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM},
906 to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the
907 linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler). So the output from
908 @samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the
909 installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into
910 distributed makefiles without careful editing.
911
912 @kindex -O @var{level}
913 @cindex generating optimized output
914 @item -O @var{level}
915 If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes
916 the output. This might take significantly longer and therefore probably
917 should only be enabled for the final binary. At the moment this
918 option only affects ELF shared library generation. Future releases of
919 the linker may make more use of this option. Also currently there is
920 no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values
921 of this option. Again this may change with future releases.
922
923 @kindex -plugin @var{name}
924 @item -plugin @var{name}
925 Involve a plugin in the linking process. The @var{name} parameter is
926 the absolute filename of the plugin. Usually this parameter is
927 automatically added by the complier, when using link time
928 optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so
929 wish.
930
931 Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different
932 from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and
933 @command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins. In order for
934 those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be
935 copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory. All gcc
936 based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to
937 just copy in the newest one.
938
939 @kindex --push-state
940 @cindex push state governing input file handling
941 @item --push-state
942 The @option{--push-state} allows one to preserve the current state of the
943 flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
944 restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option.
945
946 The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic},
947 @option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared},
948 @option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive},
949 @option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur},
950 @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries},
951 @option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}.
952
953 One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}. When
954 used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are
955 listed and then possibly linked with all the time. It is better to return
956 something as follows:
957
958 @smallexample
959 -Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
960 @end smallexample
961
962 @kindex --pop-state
963 @cindex pop state governing input file handling
964 @item --pop-state
965 Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the
966 flags governing input file handling.
967
968 @kindex -q
969 @kindex --emit-relocs
970 @cindex retain relocations in final executable
971 @item -q
972 @itemx --emit-relocs
973 Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
974 Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in
975 order to perform correct modifications of executables. This results
976 in larger executables.
977
978 This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
979
980 @kindex --force-dynamic
981 @cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections
982 @item --force-dynamic
983 Force the output file to have dynamic sections. This option is specific
984 to VxWorks targets.
985
986 @cindex partial link
987 @cindex relocatable output
988 @kindex -r
989 @kindex --relocatable
990 @item -r
991 @itemx --relocatable
992 Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in
993 turn serve as input to @command{ld}. This is often called @dfn{partial
994 linking}. As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix
995 magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to
996 @code{OMAGIC}.
997 @c ; see @option{-N}.
998 If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced. When
999 linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to
1000 constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}.
1001
1002 When an input file does not have the same format as the output file,
1003 partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any
1004 relocations. Different output formats can have further restrictions; for
1005 example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking
1006 with input files in other formats at all.
1007
1008 This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}.
1009
1010 @kindex -R @var{file}
1011 @kindex --just-symbols=@var{file}
1012 @cindex symbol-only input
1013 @item -R @var{filename}
1014 @itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename}
1015 Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not
1016 relocate it or include it in the output. This allows your output file
1017 to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other
1018 programs. You may use this option more than once.
1019
1020 For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
1021 followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
1022 the @option{-rpath} option.
1023
1024 @kindex -s
1025 @kindex --strip-all
1026 @cindex strip all symbols
1027 @item -s
1028 @itemx --strip-all
1029 Omit all symbol information from the output file.
1030
1031 @kindex -S
1032 @kindex --strip-debug
1033 @cindex strip debugger symbols
1034 @item -S
1035 @itemx --strip-debug
1036 Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file.
1037
1038 @kindex --strip-discarded
1039 @kindex --no-strip-discarded
1040 @item --strip-discarded
1041 @itemx --no-strip-discarded
1042 Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections.
1043 Enabled by default.
1044
1045 @kindex -t
1046 @kindex --trace
1047 @cindex input files, displaying
1048 @item -t
1049 @itemx --trace
1050 Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them. If
1051 @samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed.
1052 @samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files
1053 and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for
1054 a linker bug report.
1055
1056 @kindex -T @var{script}
1057 @kindex --script=@var{script}
1058 @cindex script files
1059 @item -T @var{scriptfile}
1060 @itemx --script=@var{scriptfile}
1061 Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script. This script replaces
1062 @command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it), so
1063 @var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the
1064 output file. @xref{Scripts}. If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in
1065 the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories
1066 specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options. Multiple @samp{-T}
1067 options accumulate.
1068
1069 @kindex -dT @var{script}
1070 @kindex --default-script=@var{script}
1071 @cindex script files
1072 @item -dT @var{scriptfile}
1073 @itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile}
1074 Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script. @xref{Scripts}.
1075
1076 This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that
1077 processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
1078 command line has been processed. This allows options placed after the
1079 @option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the
1080 behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker
1081 command line cannot be directly controlled by the user. (eg because
1082 the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as
1083 @samp{gcc}).
1084
1085 @kindex -u @var{symbol}
1086 @kindex --undefined=@var{symbol}
1087 @cindex undefined symbol
1088 @item -u @var{symbol}
1089 @itemx --undefined=@var{symbol}
1090 Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
1091 symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
1092 modules from standard libraries. @samp{-u} may be repeated with
1093 different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols. This
1094 option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command.
1095
1096 If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled
1097 into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain
1098 undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used
1099 instead.
1100
1101 @kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1102 @cindex symbols, require defined
1103 @cindex defined symbol
1104 @item --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1105 Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file. This option
1106 is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol}
1107 is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error
1108 and exit. The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using
1109 @code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together. This option
1110 can be used multiple times to require additional symbols.
1111
1112 @kindex -Ur
1113 @cindex constructors
1114 @item -Ur
1115 For anything other than C++ programs, this option is equivalent to
1116 @samp{-r}: it generates relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in
1117 turn serve as input to @command{ld}. When linking C++ programs, @samp{-Ur}
1118 @emph{does} resolve references to constructors, unlike @samp{-r}.
1119 It does not work to use @samp{-Ur} on files that were themselves linked
1120 with @samp{-Ur}; once the constructor table has been built, it cannot
1121 be added to. Use @samp{-Ur} only for the last partial link, and
1122 @samp{-r} for the others.
1123
1124 @kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1125 @cindex orphan sections
1126 @cindex sections, orphan
1127 @item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1128 Control how orphan sections are handled. An orphan section is one not
1129 specifically mentioned in a linker script. @xref{Orphan Sections}.
1130
1131 @var{MODE} can have any of the following values:
1132
1133 @table @code
1134 @item place
1135 Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following
1136 the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}. The option
1137 @samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed.
1138
1139 @item discard
1140 All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the
1141 @samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}).
1142
1143 @item warn
1144 The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also
1145 issue a warning.
1146
1147 @item error
1148 The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found.
1149 @end table
1150
1151 The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}.
1152
1153 @kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1154 @item --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1155 Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
1156 @var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is
1157 missing, for every orphan input section. An orphan section is one not
1158 specifically mentioned in a linker script. You may use this option
1159 multiple times on the command line; It prevents the normal merging of
1160 input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments
1161 in a linker script.
1162
1163 @kindex -v
1164 @kindex -V
1165 @kindex --version
1166 @cindex version
1167 @item -v
1168 @itemx --version
1169 @itemx -V
1170 Display the version number for @command{ld}. The @option{-V} option also
1171 lists the supported emulations.
1172
1173 @kindex -x
1174 @kindex --discard-all
1175 @cindex deleting local symbols
1176 @item -x
1177 @itemx --discard-all
1178 Delete all local symbols.
1179
1180 @kindex -X
1181 @kindex --discard-locals
1182 @cindex local symbols, deleting
1183 @item -X
1184 @itemx --discard-locals
1185 Delete all temporary local symbols. (These symbols start with
1186 system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
1187 or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.)
1188
1189 @kindex -y @var{symbol}
1190 @kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1191 @cindex symbol tracing
1192 @item -y @var{symbol}
1193 @itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1194 Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears. This
1195 option may be given any number of times. On many systems it is necessary
1196 to prepend an underscore.
1197
1198 This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but
1199 don't know where the reference is coming from.
1200
1201 @kindex -Y @var{path}
1202 @item -Y @var{path}
1203 Add @var{path} to the default library search path. This option exists
1204 for Solaris compatibility.
1205
1206 @kindex -z @var{keyword}
1207 @item -z @var{keyword}
1208 The recognized keywords are:
1209 @table @samp
1210
1211 @item bndplt
1212 Always generate BND prefix in PLT entries. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1213
1214 @item call-nop=prefix-addr
1215 @itemx call-nop=suffix-nop
1216 @itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}
1217 @itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}
1218 Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call
1219 to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot.
1220 @option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}.
1221 @option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}.
1222 @option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}.
1223 @option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}.
1224 Supported for i386 and x86_64.
1225
1226 @item cet-report=none
1227 @itemx cet-report=warning
1228 @itemx cet-report=error
1229 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and
1230 GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property
1231 section. @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1232 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1233 @option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1234 missing properties in input files. @option{cet-report=error} will make
1235 the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1236 Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing
1237 GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will
1238 turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report.
1239 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1240
1241 @item combreloc
1242 @itemx nocombreloc
1243 Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve
1244 dynamic symbol lookup caching. Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}.
1245
1246 @item common
1247 @itemx nocommon
1248 Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable
1249 link. Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}.
1250
1251 @item common-page-size=@var{value}
1252 Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}. Memory image
1253 layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is
1254 using pages of this size.
1255
1256 @item defs
1257 Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1258 is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1259 This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}.
1260
1261 @item dynamic-undefined-weak
1262 @itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak
1263 Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object,
1264 if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local
1265 by symbol visibility or versioning. Do not make them dynamic if
1266 @samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}. If neither option is given, a target
1267 may default to either option being in force, or make some other
1268 selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic. Not all targets support
1269 these options.
1270
1271 @item execstack
1272 Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
1273
1274 @item global
1275 This option is only meaningful when building a shared object. It makes
1276 the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution
1277 of subsequently loaded libraries.
1278
1279 @item globalaudit
1280 This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable.
1281 This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by
1282 setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic
1283 tag. Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via
1284 the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for
1285 all dynamic objects loaded by the application.
1286
1287 @item ibtplt
1288 Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries.
1289 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1290
1291 @item ibt
1292 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section
1293 to indicate compatibility with IBT. This also implies @option{ibtplt}.
1294 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1295
1296 @item initfirst
1297 This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
1298 It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur
1299 before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into
1300 the process at the same time. Similarly the runtime finalization of
1301 the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other
1302 objects.
1303
1304 @item interpose
1305 Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order
1306 so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared
1307 libraries not so marked.
1308
1309 @item unique
1310 @itemx nounique
1311 When generating a shared library or other dynamically loadable ELF
1312 object mark it as one that should (by default) only ever be loaded once,
1313 and only in the main namespace (when using @code{dlmopen}). This is
1314 primarily used to mark fundamental libraries such as libc, libpthread et
1315 al which do not usually function correctly unless they are the sole instances
1316 of themselves. This behaviour can be overridden by the @code{dlmopen} caller
1317 and does not apply to certain loading mechanisms (such as audit libraries).
1318
1319 @item lam-u48
1320 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 in .note.gnu.property section
1321 to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U48. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1322
1323 @item lam-u57
1324 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 in .note.gnu.property section
1325 to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U57. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1326
1327 @item lam-u48-report=none
1328 @itemx lam-u48-report=warning
1329 @itemx lam-u48-report=error
1330 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48
1331 property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1332 @option{lam-u48-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1333 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1334 @option{lam-u48-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1335 missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u48-report=error} will
1336 make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1337 Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1338
1339 @item lam-u57-report=none
1340 @itemx lam-u57-report=warning
1341 @itemx lam-u57-report=error
1342 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57
1343 property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1344 @option{lam-u57-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1345 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1346 @option{lam-u57-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1347 missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u57-report=error} will
1348 make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1349 Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1350
1351 @item lam-report=none
1352 @itemx lam-report=warning
1353 @itemx lam-report=error
1354 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 and
1355 GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 properties in input .note.gnu.property
1356 section. @option{lam-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1357 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1358 @option{lam-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1359 missing properties in input files. @option{lam-report=error} will make
1360 the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1361 Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1362
1363 @item lazy
1364 When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1365 dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when
1366 the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time.
1367 Lazy binding is the default.
1368
1369 @item loadfltr
1370 Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime.
1371
1372 @item max-page-size=@var{value}
1373 Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}.
1374
1375 @item muldefs
1376 Allow multiple definitions.
1377
1378 @item nocopyreloc
1379 Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables
1380 defined in shared libraries. May result in dynamic text relocations.
1381
1382 @item nodefaultlib
1383 Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object
1384 should ignore any default library search paths.
1385
1386 @item nodelete
1387 Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
1388
1389 @item nodlopen
1390 Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}.
1391
1392 @item nodump
1393 Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}.
1394
1395 @item noexecstack
1396 Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
1397
1398 @item noextern-protected-data
1399 Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared
1400 library. This option overrides the linker backend default. It can be
1401 used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols
1402 generated by compiler. Updates on protected data symbols by another
1403 module aren't visible to the resulting shared library. Supported for
1404 i386 and x86-64.
1405
1406 @item noreloc-overflow
1407 Disable relocation overflow check. This can be used to disable
1408 relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation
1409 overflow at run-time. Supported for x86_64.
1410
1411 @item now
1412 When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1413 dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or
1414 when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring
1415 function call resolution to the point when the function is first
1416 called.
1417
1418 @item origin
1419 Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths.
1420
1421 @item relro
1422 @itemx norelro
1423 Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object. This
1424 specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after
1425 relocation, if supported. Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller
1426 than the system page size will render this protection ineffective.
1427 Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}.
1428
1429 @item report-relative-reloc
1430 Report dynamic relative relocations generated by linker. Supported for
1431 Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1432
1433 @item separate-code
1434 @itemx noseparate-code
1435 Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object. This
1436 specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must
1437 be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data. Don't create separate
1438 code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used.
1439
1440 @item unique-symbol
1441 @itemx nounique-symbol
1442 Avoid duplicated local symbol names in the symbol string table. Append
1443 ".@code{number}" to duplicated local symbol names if @samp{unique-symbol}
1444 is used. @option{nounique-symbol} is the default.
1445
1446 @item shstk
1447 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section
1448 to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack. Supported for
1449 Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1450
1451 @item stack-size=@var{value}
1452 Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment.
1453 Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
1454 @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation.
1455
1456 @item start-stop-visibility=@var{value}
1457 @cindex visibility
1458 @cindex ELF symbol visibility
1459 Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized
1460 @code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input
1461 Section Example}). @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default},
1462 @samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}. If no @samp{-z
1463 start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for
1464 compatibility with historical practice. However, it's highly
1465 recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new
1466 programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported
1467 between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended.
1468
1469 @item text
1470 @itemx notext
1471 @itemx textoff
1472 Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent
1473 or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections. Don't
1474 report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}.
1475
1476 @item undefs
1477 Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files,
1478 either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library.
1479 This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}.
1480
1481 @item x86-64-baseline
1482 @item x86-64-v2
1483 @item x86-64-v3
1484 @itemx x86-64-v4
1485 Specify the x86-64 ISA level needed in .note.gnu.property section.
1486 @option{x86-64-baseline} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_BASELINE}.
1487 @option{x86-64-v2} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V2}.
1488 @option{x86-64-v3} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V3}.
1489 @option{x86-64-v4} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V4}.
1490 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1491
1492 @end table
1493
1494 Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
1495
1496 @kindex -(
1497 @cindex groups of archives
1498 @item -( @var{archives} -)
1499 @itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group
1500 The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files. They may be
1501 either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options.
1502
1503 The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined
1504 references are created. Normally, an archive is searched only once in
1505 the order that it is specified on the command line. If a symbol in that
1506 archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an
1507 object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker
1508 would not be able to resolve that reference. By grouping the archives,
1509 they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are
1510 resolved.
1511
1512 Using this option has a significant performance cost. It is best to use
1513 it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or
1514 more archives.
1515
1516 @kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch
1517 @kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1518 @item --accept-unknown-input-arch
1519 @itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1520 Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
1521 recognised. The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing
1522 and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files. This was
1523 the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14. The default
1524 behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and
1525 so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to
1526 restore the old behaviour.
1527
1528 @kindex --as-needed
1529 @kindex --no-as-needed
1530 @item --as-needed
1531 @itemx --no-as-needed
1532 This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned
1533 on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option. Normally
1534 the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned
1535 on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually
1536 needed or not. @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be
1537 emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a
1538 non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if
1539 the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a
1540 non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.
1541 Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after}
1542 the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
1543 needed. This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files
1544 from archives. @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour.
1545
1546 @kindex --add-needed
1547 @kindex --no-add-needed
1548 @item --add-needed
1549 @itemx --no-add-needed
1550 These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
1551 their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed}
1552 options. They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1553 and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
1554
1555 @kindex -assert @var{keyword}
1556 @item -assert @var{keyword}
1557 This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
1558
1559 @kindex -Bdynamic
1560 @kindex -dy
1561 @kindex -call_shared
1562 @item -Bdynamic
1563 @itemx -dy
1564 @itemx -call_shared
1565 Link against dynamic libraries. This is only meaningful on platforms
1566 for which shared libraries are supported. This option is normally the
1567 default on such platforms. The different variants of this option are
1568 for compatibility with various systems. You may use this option
1569 multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for
1570 @option{-l} options which follow it.
1571
1572 @kindex -Bgroup
1573 @item -Bgroup
1574 Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic
1575 section. This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
1576 object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
1577 @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied. This option is
1578 only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
1579
1580 @kindex -Bstatic
1581 @kindex -dn
1582 @kindex -non_shared
1583 @kindex -static
1584 @item -Bstatic
1585 @itemx -dn
1586 @itemx -non_shared
1587 @itemx -static
1588 Do not link against shared libraries. This is only meaningful on
1589 platforms for which shared libraries are supported. The different
1590 variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems. You
1591 may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
1592 library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it. This
1593 option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}. This
1594 option can be used with @option{-shared}. Doing so means that a
1595 shared library is being created but that all of the library's external
1596 references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static
1597 libraries.
1598
1599 @kindex -Bsymbolic
1600 @item -Bsymbolic
1601 When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the
1602 definition within the shared library, if any. Normally, it is possible
1603 for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition
1604 within the shared library. This option is only meaningful on ELF
1605 platforms which support shared libraries.
1606
1607 @kindex -Bsymbolic-functions
1608 @item -Bsymbolic-functions
1609 When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
1610 symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.
1611 This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
1612 libraries.
1613
1614 @kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1615 @item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1616 Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker. This is
1617 typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
1618 global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition
1619 within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables
1620 to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table
1621 in the executable. This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms
1622 which support shared libraries.
1623
1624 The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without
1625 scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
1626
1627 @kindex --dynamic-list-data
1628 @item --dynamic-list-data
1629 Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
1630
1631 @kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1632 @item --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1633 Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete. It
1634 is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
1635
1636 @kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1637 @item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1638 Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification.
1639
1640 @kindex --check-sections
1641 @kindex --no-check-sections
1642 @item --check-sections
1643 @itemx --no-check-sections
1644 Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have
1645 been assigned to see if there are any overlaps. Normally the linker will
1646 perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce
1647 suitable error messages. The linker does know about, and does make
1648 allowances for sections in overlays. The default behaviour can be
1649 restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}.
1650 Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links. You can
1651 force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections}
1652 option.
1653
1654 @kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries
1655 @kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1656 @item --copy-dt-needed-entries
1657 @itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1658 This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
1659 by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
1660 command line. Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
1661 output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
1662 input dynamic library. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1663 specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that
1664 follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added. The default
1665 behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
1666
1667 This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic
1668 libraries. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries
1669 mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following
1670 their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols
1671 required by the output binary. With the default setting however
1672 the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the
1673 dynamic library itself. No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve
1674 symbols.
1675
1676 @cindex cross reference table
1677 @kindex --cref
1678 @item --cref
1679 Output a cross reference table. If a linker map file is being
1680 generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
1681 Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
1682
1683 The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
1684 easily processed by a script if necessary. The symbols are printed out,
1685 sorted by name. For each symbol, a list of file names is given. If the
1686 symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the
1687 definition. If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files
1688 where this happens appear next. Finally any files that reference the
1689 symbol are listed.
1690
1691 @cindex ctf variables
1692 @kindex --ctf-variables
1693 @kindex --no-ctf-variables
1694 @item --ctf-variables
1695 @item --no-ctf-variables
1696 The CTF debuginfo format supports a section which encodes the names and
1697 types of variables found in the program which do not appear in any symbol
1698 table. These variables clearly cannot be looked up by address by
1699 conventional debuggers, so the space used for their types and names is
1700 usually wasted: the types are usually small but the names are often not.
1701 @option{--ctf-variables} causes the generation of such a section.
1702 The default behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-ctf-variables}.
1703
1704 @cindex ctf type sharing
1705 @kindex --ctf-share-types
1706 @item --ctf-share-types=@var{method}
1707 Adjust the method used to share types between translation units in CTF.
1708
1709 @table @samp
1710 @item share-unconflicted
1711 Put all types that do not have ambiguous definitions into the shared dictionary,
1712 where debuggers can easily access them, even if they only occur in one
1713 translation unit. This is the default.
1714
1715 @item share-duplicated
1716 Put only types that occur in multiple translation units into the shared
1717 dictionary: types with only one definition go into per-translation-unit
1718 dictionaries. Types with ambiguous definitions in multiple translation units
1719 always go into per-translation-unit dictionaries. This tends to make the CTF
1720 larger, but may reduce the amount of CTF in the shared dictionary. For very
1721 large projects this may speed up opening the CTF and save memory in the CTF
1722 consumer at runtime.
1723 @end table
1724
1725 @cindex common allocation
1726 @kindex --no-define-common
1727 @item --no-define-common
1728 This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
1729 The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
1730 @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1731
1732 The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling
1733 the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice
1734 of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type
1735 forces assigning addresses to Common symbols.
1736 Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced
1737 from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program.
1738 This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library,
1739 and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
1740 duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search
1741 paths for runtime symbol resolution.
1742
1743 @cindex group allocation in linker script
1744 @cindex section groups
1745 @cindex COMDAT
1746 @kindex --force-group-allocation
1747 @item --force-group-allocation
1748 This option causes the linker to place section group members like
1749 normal input sections, and to delete the section groups. This is the
1750 default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to
1751 change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}). The script
1752 command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same
1753 effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1754
1755 @cindex symbols, from command line
1756 @kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp}
1757 @item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression}
1758 Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
1759 address given by @var{expression}. You may use this option as many
1760 times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line. A
1761 limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this
1762 context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing
1763 symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal
1764 constants or symbols. If you need more elaborate expressions, consider
1765 using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}).
1766 @emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the
1767 equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}.
1768
1769 The linker processes @samp{--defsym} arguments and @samp{-T} arguments
1770 in order, placing @samp{--defsym} before @samp{-T} will define the
1771 symbol before the linker script from @samp{-T} is processed, while
1772 placing @samp{--defsym} after @samp{-T} will define the symbol after
1773 the linker script has been processed. This difference has
1774 consequences for expressions within the linker script that use the
1775 @samp{--defsym} symbols, which order is correct will depend on what
1776 you are trying to achieve.
1777
1778 @cindex demangling, from command line
1779 @kindex --demangle[=@var{style}]
1780 @kindex --no-demangle
1781 @item --demangle[=@var{style}]
1782 @itemx --no-demangle
1783 These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages
1784 and other output. When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to
1785 present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading
1786 underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++
1787 mangled symbol names into user readable names. Different compilers have
1788 different mangling styles. The optional demangling style argument can be used
1789 to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler. The linker will
1790 demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}
1791 is set. These options may be used to override the default.
1792
1793 @cindex dynamic linker, from command line
1794 @kindex -I@var{file}
1795 @kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1796 @item -I@var{file}
1797 @itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1798 Set the name of the dynamic linker. This is only meaningful when
1799 generating dynamically linked ELF executables. The default dynamic
1800 linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are
1801 doing.
1802
1803 @kindex --no-dynamic-linker
1804 @item --no-dynamic-linker
1805 When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic
1806 linker to be used at load-time. This is only meaningful for ELF
1807 executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires
1808 entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations.
1809
1810 @kindex --embedded-relocs
1811 @item --embedded-relocs
1812 This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except
1813 that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section. This option
1814 is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K}
1815 targets.
1816
1817 @kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1818 @item --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1819 Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included
1820 in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols
1821
1822 @kindex --fatal-warnings
1823 @kindex --no-fatal-warnings
1824 @item --fatal-warnings
1825 @itemx --no-fatal-warnings
1826 Treat all warnings as errors. The default behaviour can be restored
1827 with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}.
1828
1829 @kindex --force-exe-suffix
1830 @item --force-exe-suffix
1831 Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
1832
1833 If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
1834 @code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy
1835 the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This
1836 option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft
1837 Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless
1838 it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix.
1839
1840 @kindex --gc-sections
1841 @kindex --no-gc-sections
1842 @cindex garbage collection
1843 @item --gc-sections
1844 @itemx --no-gc-sections
1845 Enable garbage collection of unused input sections. It is ignored on
1846 targets that do not support this option. The default behaviour (of not
1847 performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying
1848 @samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line. Note that garbage
1849 collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the
1850 implementation is currently considered to be experimental.
1851
1852 @samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by
1853 examining symbols and relocations. The section containing the entry
1854 symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the
1855 command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols
1856 referenced by dynamic objects. Note that when building shared
1857 libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is
1858 referenced. Once this initial set of sections has been determined,
1859 the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
1860 relocations. See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and
1861 @samp{--gc-keep-exported}.
1862
1863 This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option
1864 @samp{-r}). In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly
1865 specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry},
1866 @samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY}
1867 command in the linker script.
1868
1869 As a GNU extension, ELF input sections marked with the
1870 @code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN} flag will not be garbage collected.
1871
1872 @kindex --print-gc-sections
1873 @kindex --no-print-gc-sections
1874 @cindex garbage collection
1875 @item --print-gc-sections
1876 @itemx --no-print-gc-sections
1877 List all sections removed by garbage collection. The listing is
1878 printed on stderr. This option is only effective if garbage
1879 collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option. The
1880 default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can
1881 be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command
1882 line.
1883
1884 @kindex --gc-keep-exported
1885 @cindex garbage collection
1886 @item --gc-keep-exported
1887 When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage
1888 collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having
1889 default or protected visibility. This option is intended to be used for
1890 executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage
1891 collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols.
1892 Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since
1893 it is already the default behaviour. This option is only supported for
1894 ELF format targets.
1895
1896 @kindex --print-output-format
1897 @cindex output format
1898 @item --print-output-format
1899 Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
1900 other command-line options). This is the string that would appear
1901 in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}).
1902
1903 @kindex --print-memory-usage
1904 @cindex memory usage
1905 @item --print-memory-usage
1906 Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with
1907 the @ref{MEMORY} command. This is useful on embedded targets to have a
1908 quick view of amount of free memory. The format of the output has one
1909 headline and one line per region. It is both human readable and easily
1910 parsable by tools. Here is an example of an output:
1911
1912 @smallexample
1913 Memory region Used Size Region Size %age Used
1914 ROM: 256 KB 1 MB 25.00%
1915 RAM: 32 B 2 GB 0.00%
1916 @end smallexample
1917
1918 @cindex help
1919 @cindex usage
1920 @kindex --help
1921 @item --help
1922 Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit.
1923
1924 @kindex --target-help
1925 @item --target-help
1926 Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit.
1927
1928 @kindex -Map=@var{mapfile}
1929 @item -Map=@var{mapfile}
1930 Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}. See the description of the
1931 @option{-M} option, above. If @var{mapfile} is just the character
1932 @code{-} then the map will be written to stdout.
1933
1934 Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile} causes the linker map to be
1935 written as a file inside the directory. Normally name of the file
1936 inside the directory is computed as the basename of the @var{output}
1937 file with @code{.map} appended. If however the special character
1938 @code{%} is used then this will be replaced by the full path of the
1939 output file. Additionally if there are any characters after the
1940 @var{%} symbol then @code{.map} will no longer be appended.
1941
1942 @smallexample
1943 -o foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
1944 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
1945 -o foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1946 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1947 -o foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ./foo.exe.map]
1948 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1949 -o foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ./foo.exe.bar]
1950 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.bar]
1951 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/% [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.map]
1952 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/%.bar [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.bar]
1953 @end smallexample
1954
1955 It is an error to specify more than one @code{%} character.
1956
1957 If the map file already exists then it will be overwritten by this
1958 operation.
1959
1960 @cindex memory usage
1961 @kindex --no-keep-memory
1962 @item --no-keep-memory
1963 @command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
1964 symbol tables of input files in memory. This option tells @command{ld} to
1965 instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as
1966 necessary. This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space
1967 while linking a large executable.
1968
1969 @kindex --no-undefined
1970 @kindex -z defs
1971 @kindex -z undefs
1972 @item --no-undefined
1973 @itemx -z defs
1974 Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1975 is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1976 The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the
1977 behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
1978 libraries being linked in.
1979
1980 The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}.
1981
1982 @kindex --allow-multiple-definition
1983 @kindex -z muldefs
1984 @item --allow-multiple-definition
1985 @itemx -z muldefs
1986 Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
1987 report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the
1988 first definition will be used.
1989
1990 @kindex --allow-shlib-undefined
1991 @kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined
1992 @item --allow-shlib-undefined
1993 @itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined
1994 Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.
1995 This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it
1996 determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a
1997 shared library rather than a regular object file. It does not affect
1998 how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
1999
2000 The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
2001 referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create
2002 an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create
2003 a shared library.
2004
2005 The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
2006 libraries specified at link time are that:
2007
2008 @itemize @bullet
2009 @item
2010 A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one
2011 that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be
2012 resolvable at load time.
2013 @item
2014 There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined
2015 symbols in shared libraries are normal.
2016
2017 The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to
2018 select whichever function is most appropriate for the current
2019 architecture. This is used, for example, to dynamically select an
2020 appropriate memset function.
2021 @end itemize
2022
2023 @kindex --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2024 @item --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2025 If this option is provided then the linker will invoke
2026 @var{scriptname} whenever an error is encountered. Currently however
2027 only two kinds of error are supported: missing symbols and missing
2028 libraries. Two arguments will be passed to script: the keyword
2029 ``undefined-symbol'' or `missing-lib'' and the @var{name} of the
2030 undefined symbol or missing library. The intention is that the script
2031 will provide suggestions to the user as to where the symbol or library
2032 might be found. After the script has finished then the normal linker
2033 error message will be displayed.
2034
2035 The availability of this option is controlled by a configure time
2036 switch, so it may not be present in specific implementations.
2037
2038 @kindex --no-undefined-version
2039 @item --no-undefined-version
2040 Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore
2041 it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error
2042 will be issued instead.
2043
2044 @kindex --default-symver
2045 @item --default-symver
2046 Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2047 exported symbols.
2048
2049 @kindex --default-imported-symver
2050 @item --default-imported-symver
2051 Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2052 imported symbols.
2053
2054 @kindex --no-warn-mismatch
2055 @item --no-warn-mismatch
2056 Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input
2057 files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have
2058 been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses.
2059 This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible
2060 errors. This option should only be used with care, in cases when you
2061 have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are
2062 inappropriate.
2063
2064 @kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch
2065 @item --no-warn-search-mismatch
2066 Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
2067 library during a library search. This option silences the warning.
2068
2069 @kindex --no-whole-archive
2070 @item --no-whole-archive
2071 Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent
2072 archive files.
2073
2074 @cindex output file after errors
2075 @kindex --noinhibit-exec
2076 @item --noinhibit-exec
2077 Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
2078 Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters
2079 errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file
2080 when it issues any error whatsoever.
2081
2082 @kindex -nostdlib
2083 @item -nostdlib
2084 Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
2085 command line. Library directories specified in linker scripts
2086 (including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored.
2087
2088 @ifclear SingleFormat
2089 @kindex --oformat=@var{output-format}
2090 @item --oformat=@var{output-format}
2091 @command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
2092 file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
2093 @samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output
2094 object file. Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative
2095 object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld}
2096 should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
2097 usual format on each machine. @var{output-format} is a text string, the
2098 name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries. (You can
2099 list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.) The script
2100 command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but
2101 this option overrides it. @xref{BFD}.
2102 @end ifclear
2103
2104 @kindex --out-implib
2105 @item --out-implib @var{file}
2106 Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable
2107 the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program). This import
2108 library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs)
2109 may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this
2110 behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation
2111 step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs). This option is only available for
2112 the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker.
2113
2114 @kindex -pie
2115 @kindex --pic-executable
2116 @item -pie
2117 @itemx --pic-executable
2118 @cindex position independent executables
2119 Create a position independent executable. This is currently only supported on
2120 ELF platforms. Position independent executables are similar to shared
2121 libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual
2122 address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations). Like
2123 normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols
2124 defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
2125
2126 @kindex -qmagic
2127 @item -qmagic
2128 This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
2129
2130 @kindex -Qy
2131 @item -Qy
2132 This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
2133
2134 @kindex --relax
2135 @cindex synthesizing linker
2136 @cindex relaxing addressing modes
2137 @cindex --no-relax
2138 @item --relax
2139 @itemx --no-relax
2140 An option with machine dependent effects.
2141 @ifset GENERIC
2142 This option is only supported on a few targets.
2143 @end ifset
2144 @ifset H8300
2145 @xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}.
2146 @end ifset
2147 @ifset XTENSA
2148 @xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}.
2149 @end ifset
2150 @ifset M68HC11
2151 @xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}.
2152 @end ifset
2153 @ifset NIOSII
2154 @xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}.
2155 @end ifset
2156 @ifset POWERPC
2157 @xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}.
2158 @end ifset
2159
2160 On some platforms the @option{--relax} option performs target specific,
2161 global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
2162 addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
2163 synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
2164 instructions, and combining constant values.
2165
2166 On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic
2167 debugging of the resulting executable impossible.
2168 @ifset GENERIC
2169 This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
2170 family of processors.
2171 @end ifset
2172
2173 On platforms where the feature is supported, the option
2174 @option{--no-relax} will disable it.
2175
2176 On platforms where the feature is not supported, both @option{--relax}
2177 and @option{--no-relax} are accepted, but ignored.
2178
2179 @cindex retaining specified symbols
2180 @cindex stripping all but some symbols
2181 @cindex symbols, retaining selectively
2182 @kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2183 @item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2184 Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename},
2185 discarding all others. @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one
2186 symbol name per line. This option is especially useful in environments
2187 @ifset GENERIC
2188 (such as VxWorks)
2189 @end ifset
2190 where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve
2191 run-time memory.
2192
2193 @samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols,
2194 or symbols needed for relocations.
2195
2196 You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command
2197 line. It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}.
2198
2199 @ifset GENERIC
2200 @item -rpath=@var{dir}
2201 @cindex runtime library search path
2202 @kindex -rpath=@var{dir}
2203 Add a directory to the runtime library search path. This is used when
2204 linking an ELF executable with shared objects. All @option{-rpath}
2205 arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses
2206 them to locate shared objects at runtime.
2207
2208 The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which
2209 are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
2210 description of the @option{-rpath-link} option. Searching @option{-rpath}
2211 in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which
2212 have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2213
2214 If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the
2215 contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it
2216 is defined.
2217
2218 The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS. By default, on
2219 SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the
2220 @option{-L} options it is given. If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the
2221 runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath}
2222 options, ignoring the @option{-L} options. This can be useful when using
2223 gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted
2224 file systems.
2225
2226 For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
2227 followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
2228 the @option{-rpath} option.
2229 @end ifset
2230
2231 @ifset GENERIC
2232 @cindex link-time runtime library search path
2233 @kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2234 @item -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2235 When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another. This
2236 happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one
2237 of the input files.
2238
2239 When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared,
2240 non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required
2241 shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included
2242 explicitly. In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option
2243 specifies the first set of directories to search. The
2244 @option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names
2245 either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
2246 appearing multiple times.
2247
2248 The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search
2249 directories. They will be replaced by the full path to the directory
2250 containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN}
2251 and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for
2252 64-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}.
2253
2254 The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and
2255 @var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used. The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not
2256 supported.
2257
2258 This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path
2259 that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it
2260 is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the
2261 runtime linker would do.
2262
2263 The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared
2264 libraries:
2265
2266 @enumerate
2267 @item
2268 Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options.
2269 @item
2270 Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options. The difference
2271 between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories
2272 specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and
2273 used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective
2274 at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported
2275 by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with
2276 the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2277 @item
2278 On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and
2279 @option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the
2280 environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}.
2281 @item
2282 On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any
2283 directories specified using @option{-L} options.
2284 @item
2285 For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
2286 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}.
2287 @item
2288 For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or
2289 @code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared
2290 libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if
2291 @code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist.
2292 @item
2293 The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}.
2294 @item
2295 For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf}
2296 exists, the list of directories found in that file. Note: the path
2297 to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is
2298 defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was
2299 configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option.
2300 @item
2301 For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by
2302 the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h}
2303 header file.
2304 @item
2305 Any directories specifed by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in the
2306 linker script being used.
2307 @end enumerate
2308
2309 If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a
2310 warning and continue with the link.
2311 @end ifset
2312
2313 @kindex -shared
2314 @kindex -Bshareable
2315 @item -shared
2316 @itemx -Bshareable
2317 @cindex shared libraries
2318 Create a shared library. This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF
2319 and SunOS platforms. On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a
2320 shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are
2321 undefined symbols in the link.
2322
2323 @kindex --sort-common
2324 @item --sort-common
2325 @itemx --sort-common=ascending
2326 @itemx --sort-common=descending
2327 This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in
2328 ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output
2329 sections. The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger,
2330 eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps
2331 between symbols due to alignment constraints. If no sorting order is
2332 specified, then descending order is assumed.
2333
2334 @kindex --sort-section=name
2335 @item --sort-section=name
2336 This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section
2337 patterns in the linker script.
2338
2339 @kindex --sort-section=alignment
2340 @item --sort-section=alignment
2341 This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section
2342 patterns in the linker script.
2343
2344 @kindex --spare-dynamic-tags
2345 @item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count}
2346 This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the
2347 .dynamic section of ELF shared objects. Empty slots may be needed by
2348 post processing tools, such as the prelinker. The default is 5.
2349
2350 @kindex --split-by-file
2351 @item --split-by-file[=@var{size}]
2352 Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for
2353 each input file when @var{size} is reached. @var{size} defaults to a
2354 size of 1 if not given.
2355
2356 @kindex --split-by-reloc
2357 @item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}]
2358 Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single
2359 output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations.
2360 This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into
2361 certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF
2362 cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section. Note
2363 that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not
2364 support arbitrary sections. The linker will not split up individual
2365 input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains
2366 more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that
2367 many relocations. @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768.
2368
2369 @kindex --stats
2370 @item --stats
2371 Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such
2372 as execution time and memory usage.
2373
2374 @kindex --sysroot=@var{directory}
2375 @item --sysroot=@var{directory}
2376 Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
2377 configure-time default. This option is only supported by linkers
2378 that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}.
2379
2380 @kindex --task-link
2381 @item --task-link
2382 This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object
2383 file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics.
2384
2385 @kindex --traditional-format
2386 @cindex traditional format
2387 @item --traditional-format
2388 For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from
2389 the output of some existing linker. This switch requests @command{ld} to
2390 use the traditional format instead.
2391
2392 @cindex dbx
2393 For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the
2394 symbol string table. This can reduce the size of an output file with
2395 full debugging information by over 30 percent. Unfortunately, the SunOS
2396 @code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no
2397 trouble). The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not
2398 combine duplicate entries.
2399
2400 @kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2401 @item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2402 Locate a section in the output file at the absolute
2403 address given by @var{org}. You may use this option as many
2404 times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command
2405 line.
2406 @var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer;
2407 for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading
2408 @samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values. @emph{Note:} there
2409 should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals
2410 sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}.
2411
2412 @kindex -Tbss=@var{org}
2413 @kindex -Tdata=@var{org}
2414 @kindex -Ttext=@var{org}
2415 @cindex segment origins, cmd line
2416 @item -Tbss=@var{org}
2417 @itemx -Tdata=@var{org}
2418 @itemx -Ttext=@var{org}
2419 Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or
2420 @code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}.
2421
2422 @kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2423 @item -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2424 @cindex text segment origin, cmd line
2425 When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first
2426 byte of the text segment.
2427
2428 @kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2429 @item -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2430 @cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line
2431 When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
2432 the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable
2433 text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment.
2434
2435 @kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2436 @item -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2437 @cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line
2438 When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory
2439 model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment.
2440
2441 @kindex --unresolved-symbols
2442 @item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method}
2443 Determine how to handle unresolved symbols. There are four possible
2444 values for @samp{method}:
2445
2446 @table @samp
2447 @item ignore-all
2448 Do not report any unresolved symbols.
2449
2450 @item report-all
2451 Report all unresolved symbols. This is the default.
2452
2453 @item ignore-in-object-files
2454 Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but
2455 ignore them if they come from regular object files.
2456
2457 @item ignore-in-shared-libs
2458 Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but
2459 ignore them if they come from shared libraries. This can be useful
2460 when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared
2461 libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's
2462 command line.
2463 @end table
2464
2465 The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled
2466 by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option.
2467
2468 Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported
2469 unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols}
2470 can change this to a warning.
2471
2472 @kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2473 @cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2474 @item --dll-verbose
2475 @itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2476 Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations
2477 supported. Display which input files can and cannot be opened. Display
2478 the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER}
2479 argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed.
2480
2481 @kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2482 @cindex version script, symbol versions
2483 @item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2484 Specify the name of a version script to the linker. This is typically
2485 used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information
2486 about the version hierarchy for the library being created. This option
2487 is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries;
2488 see @ref{VERSION}. It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can
2489 use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
2490 symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported.
2491 @xref{WIN32}.
2492
2493 @kindex --warn-common
2494 @cindex warnings, on combining symbols
2495 @cindex combining symbols, warnings on
2496 @item --warn-common
2497 Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with
2498 a symbol definition. Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice,
2499 but linkers on some other operating systems do not. This option allows
2500 you to find potential problems from combining global symbols.
2501 Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some
2502 warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs.
2503
2504 There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples:
2505
2506 @table @samp
2507 @item int i = 1;
2508 A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output
2509 file.
2510
2511 @item extern int i;
2512 An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.
2513 There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
2514 variable somewhere.
2515
2516 @item int i;
2517 A common symbol. If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a
2518 variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file.
2519 The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a
2520 single symbol. If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest
2521 size. The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
2522 a definition of the same variable.
2523 @end table
2524
2525 The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings.
2526 Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol
2527 just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol
2528 encountered with the same name. One or both of the two symbols will be
2529 a common symbol.
2530
2531 @enumerate
2532 @item
2533 Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a
2534 definition for the symbol.
2535 @smallexample
2536 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2537 overridden by definition
2538 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here
2539 @end smallexample
2540
2541 @item
2542 Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for
2543 the symbol is encountered. This is the same as the previous case,
2544 except that the symbols are encountered in a different order.
2545 @smallexample
2546 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}'
2547 overriding common
2548 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here
2549 @end smallexample
2550
2551 @item
2552 Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol.
2553 @smallexample
2554 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common
2555 of `@var{symbol}'
2556 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here
2557 @end smallexample
2558
2559 @item
2560 Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
2561 @smallexample
2562 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2563 overridden by larger common
2564 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here
2565 @end smallexample
2566
2567 @item
2568 Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol. This is
2569 the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are
2570 encountered in a different order.
2571 @smallexample
2572 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2573 overriding smaller common
2574 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here
2575 @end smallexample
2576 @end enumerate
2577
2578 @kindex --warn-constructors
2579 @item --warn-constructors
2580 Warn if any global constructors are used. This is only useful for a few
2581 object file formats. For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not
2582 detect the use of global constructors.
2583
2584 @kindex --warn-multiple-gp
2585 @item --warn-multiple-gp
2586 Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file.
2587 This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha.
2588 Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special
2589 section. A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle
2590 of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a
2591 base-register relative addressing mode. Since the offset in
2592 base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16
2593 bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool. Thus, in
2594 large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer
2595 values in order to be able to address all possible constants. This
2596 option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs.
2597
2598 @kindex --warn-once
2599 @cindex warnings, on undefined symbols
2600 @cindex undefined symbols, warnings on
2601 @item --warn-once
2602 Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module
2603 which refers to it.
2604
2605 @kindex --warn-section-align
2606 @cindex warnings, on section alignment
2607 @cindex section alignment, warnings on
2608 @item --warn-section-align
2609 Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
2610 alignment. Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section.
2611 The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that
2612 is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for
2613 the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}).
2614
2615 @kindex --warn-textrel
2616 @item --warn-textrel
2617 Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable
2618 or shared object.
2619
2620 @kindex --warn-alternate-em
2621 @item --warn-alternate-em
2622 Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
2623
2624 @kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols
2625 @item --warn-unresolved-symbols
2626 If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option
2627 @option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error.
2628 This option makes it generate a warning instead.
2629
2630 @kindex --error-unresolved-symbols
2631 @item --error-unresolved-symbols
2632 This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when
2633 it is reporting unresolved symbols.
2634
2635 @kindex --whole-archive
2636 @cindex including an entire archive
2637 @item --whole-archive
2638 For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
2639 @option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive
2640 in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object
2641 files. This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared
2642 library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared
2643 library. This option may be used more than once.
2644
2645 Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
2646 about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}.
2647 Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your
2648 list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
2649 your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
2650
2651 @kindex --wrap=@var{symbol}
2652 @item --wrap=@var{symbol}
2653 Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}. Any undefined reference to
2654 @var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. Any
2655 undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to
2656 @var{symbol}.
2657
2658 This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function. The
2659 wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. If it
2660 wishes to call the system function, it should call
2661 @code{__real_@var{symbol}}.
2662
2663 Here is a trivial example:
2664
2665 @smallexample
2666 void *
2667 __wrap_malloc (size_t c)
2668 @{
2669 printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
2670 return __real_malloc (c);
2671 @}
2672 @end smallexample
2673
2674 If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then
2675 all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc}
2676 instead. The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will
2677 call the real @code{malloc} function.
2678
2679 You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that
2680 links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed. If you do this,
2681 you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same
2682 file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
2683 call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}.
2684
2685 Only undefined references are replaced by the linker. So, translation unit
2686 internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to
2687 @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. In the next example, the call to @code{f} in
2688 @code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}.
2689
2690 @smallexample
2691 int
2692 f (void)
2693 @{
2694 return 123;
2695 @}
2696
2697 int
2698 g (void)
2699 @{
2700 return f();
2701 @}
2702 @end smallexample
2703
2704 @kindex --eh-frame-hdr
2705 @kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr
2706 @item --eh-frame-hdr
2707 @itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr
2708 Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress
2709 (@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr}
2710 section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header.
2711
2712 @kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info
2713 @item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info
2714 Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker
2715 generated code sections like PLT. This option is on by default
2716 if linker generated unwind info is supported.
2717
2718 @kindex --enable-new-dtags
2719 @kindex --disable-new-dtags
2720 @item --enable-new-dtags
2721 @itemx --disable-new-dtags
2722 This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF
2723 systems may not understand them. If you specify
2724 @option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed
2725 and older dynamic tags will be omitted.
2726 If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be
2727 created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that
2728 those options are only available for ELF systems.
2729
2730 @kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
2731 @item --hash-size=@var{number}
2732 Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
2733 close to @var{number}. Increasing this value can reduce the length of
2734 time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
2735 increasing the linker's memory requirements. Similarly reducing this
2736 value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed.
2737
2738 @kindex --hash-style=@var{style}
2739 @item --hash-style=@var{style}
2740 Set the type of linker's hash table(s). @var{style} can be either
2741 @code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for
2742 new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both
2743 the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash}
2744 hash tables. The default depends upon how the linker was configured,
2745 but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}.
2746
2747 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=none
2748 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2749 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2750 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2751 @item --compress-debug-sections=none
2752 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2753 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2754 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2755 On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are
2756 compressed using zlib.
2757
2758 @option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug
2759 sections. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses
2760 DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug}
2761 instead of @samp{.debug}. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}
2762 also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it
2763 sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers.
2764
2765 The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for
2766 @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}.
2767
2768 Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug
2769 sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none}
2770 for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be
2771 uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary.
2772
2773 The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target
2774 involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain. The
2775 default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's
2776 @option{--help} option.
2777
2778 @kindex --reduce-memory-overheads
2779 @item --reduce-memory-overheads
2780 This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of
2781 linking speed. This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm
2782 for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses
2783 about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
2784
2785 Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to
2786 1021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's
2787 run time. This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch
2788 has been used.
2789
2790 The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to
2791 enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
2792
2793 @kindex --build-id
2794 @kindex --build-id=@var{style}
2795 @item --build-id
2796 @itemx --build-id=@var{style}
2797 Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section
2798 or a @code{.buildid} COFF section. The contents of the note are
2799 unique bits identifying this linked file. @var{style} can be
2800 @code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit
2801 @sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents,
2802 @code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of
2803 the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit
2804 string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and
2805 @code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored). If @var{style}
2806 is omitted, @code{sha1} is used.
2807
2808 The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier
2809 that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be
2810 unique among all nonidentical output files. It is not intended
2811 to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents. A linked
2812 file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit
2813 string identifying the original linked file does not change.
2814
2815 Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any
2816 @code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line.
2817 @end table
2818
2819 @c man end
2820
2821 @subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
2822
2823 @c man begin OPTIONS
2824
2825 The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes
2826 the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a
2827 normal executable. You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you
2828 use this option. In addition, the linker fully supports the standard
2829 @code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line
2830 like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports
2831 symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal
2832 object file).
2833
2834 In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
2835 support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386
2836 PE target. Options that take values may be separated from their
2837 values by either a space or an equals sign.
2838
2839 @table @gcctabopt
2840
2841 @kindex --add-stdcall-alias
2842 @item --add-stdcall-alias
2843 If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported
2844 as-is and also with the suffix stripped.
2845 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2846
2847 @kindex --base-file
2848 @item --base-file @var{file}
2849 Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base
2850 addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with
2851 @file{dlltool}.
2852 [This is an i386 PE specific option]
2853
2854 @kindex --dll
2855 @item --dll
2856 Create a DLL instead of a regular executable. You may also use
2857 @option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def}
2858 file.
2859 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2860
2861 @kindex --enable-long-section-names
2862 @kindex --disable-long-section-names
2863 @item --enable-long-section-names
2864 @itemx --disable-long-section-names
2865 The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits
2866 the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit
2867 for COFF. By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as
2868 fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required
2869 to support the longer names. As a GNU extension, it is possible to
2870 allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)
2871 disallow it in object files, by using these two options. Executable images
2872 generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying
2873 as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined
2874 with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers. However,
2875 GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug
2876 information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither
2877 option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long
2878 section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour,
2879 when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
2880 image and not stripping symbols.
2881 [This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker]
2882
2883 @kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup
2884 @kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup
2885 @item --enable-stdcall-fixup
2886 @itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup
2887 If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to
2888 do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs
2889 only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will
2890 resolve that symbol by linking to the match. For example, the
2891 undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function
2892 @code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked
2893 to the function @code{_bar}. When the linker does this, it prints a
2894 warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes
2895 import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature
2896 to be usable. If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this
2897 feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed. If you specify
2898 @option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such
2899 mismatches are considered to be errors.
2900 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2901
2902 @kindex --leading-underscore
2903 @kindex --no-leading-underscore
2904 @item --leading-underscore
2905 @itemx --no-leading-underscore
2906 For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined
2907 in target's description. By this option it is possible to
2908 disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
2909
2910 @cindex DLLs, creating
2911 @kindex --export-all-symbols
2912 @item --export-all-symbols
2913 If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will
2914 be exported by the DLL. Note that this is the default if there
2915 otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols. When symbols are
2916 explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function
2917 attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this
2918 option is given. Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12},
2919 @code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and
2920 @code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically
2921 exported. Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be
2922 re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout
2923 such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with
2924 @code{_iname}. In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc},
2925 @code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported.
2926 Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will
2927 not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs. Finally, there is an
2928 extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported
2929 (obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).
2930 These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12},
2931 @code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12},
2932 @code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll},
2933 @code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2},
2934 @code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}.
2935 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2936
2937 @kindex --exclude-symbols
2938 @item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},...
2939 Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
2940 exported. The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
2941 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2942
2943 @kindex --exclude-all-symbols
2944 @item --exclude-all-symbols
2945 Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.
2946 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2947
2948 @kindex --file-alignment
2949 @item --file-alignment
2950 Specify the file alignment. Sections in the file will always begin at
2951 file offsets which are multiples of this number. This defaults to
2952 512.
2953 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2954
2955 @cindex heap size
2956 @kindex --heap
2957 @item --heap @var{reserve}
2958 @itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit}
2959 Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
2960 to be used as heap for this program. The default is 1MB reserved, 4K
2961 committed.
2962 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2963
2964 @cindex image base
2965 @kindex --image-base
2966 @item --image-base @var{value}
2967 Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll. This is
2968 the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
2969 is loaded. To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of
2970 your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any
2971 other dlls. The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000
2972 for dlls.
2973 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2974
2975 @kindex --kill-at
2976 @item --kill-at
2977 If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from
2978 symbols before they are exported.
2979 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2980
2981 @kindex --large-address-aware
2982 @item --large-address-aware
2983 If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF
2984 header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses
2985 greater than 2 gigabytes. This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB
2986 or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]''
2987 section of the BOOT.INI. Otherwise, this bit has no effect.
2988 [This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
2989
2990 @kindex --disable-large-address-aware
2991 @item --disable-large-address-aware
2992 Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option.
2993 This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler
2994 driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual
2995 addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.
2996 [This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
2997
2998 @kindex --major-image-version
2999 @item --major-image-version @var{value}
3000 Sets the major number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 1.
3001 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3002
3003 @kindex --major-os-version
3004 @item --major-os-version @var{value}
3005 Sets the major number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 4.
3006 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3007
3008 @kindex --major-subsystem-version
3009 @item --major-subsystem-version @var{value}
3010 Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 4.
3011 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3012
3013 @kindex --minor-image-version
3014 @item --minor-image-version @var{value}
3015 Sets the minor number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 0.
3016 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3017
3018 @kindex --minor-os-version
3019 @item --minor-os-version @var{value}
3020 Sets the minor number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 0.
3021 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3022
3023 @kindex --minor-subsystem-version
3024 @item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value}
3025 Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 0.
3026 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3027
3028 @cindex DEF files, creating
3029 @cindex DLLs, creating
3030 @kindex --output-def
3031 @item --output-def @var{file}
3032 The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF
3033 file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating. This DEF file
3034 (which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import
3035 library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to
3036 automatically or implicitly exported symbols.
3037 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3038
3039 @cindex DLLs, creating
3040 @kindex --enable-auto-image-base
3041 @item --enable-auto-image-base
3042 @itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value}
3043 Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base
3044 @var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument.
3045 By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases
3046 for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program
3047 execution are avoided.
3048 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3049
3050 @kindex --disable-auto-image-base
3051 @item --disable-auto-image-base
3052 Do not automatically generate a unique image base. If there is no
3053 user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform
3054 default.
3055 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3056
3057 @cindex DLLs, linking to
3058 @kindex --dll-search-prefix
3059 @item --dll-search-prefix @var{string}
3060 When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
3061 search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to
3062 @code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction
3063 between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
3064 uwin, pw, etc. For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
3065 @code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}.
3066 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3067
3068 @kindex --enable-auto-import
3069 @item --enable-auto-import
3070 Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for
3071 DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport
3072 mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names.
3073 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3074
3075 The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the
3076 feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
3077
3078 Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section
3079 of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
3080 PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
3081
3082 Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
3083 data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
3084 placed into the .data section instead. This is in order to work
3085 around a problem with consts that is described here:
3086 http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
3087
3088 Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may
3089 see this message:
3090
3091 "variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
3092 documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
3093
3094 This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
3095 ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only
3096 allow one). Instances where this may occur include accesses to member
3097 fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a
3098 constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL. Any
3099 multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger
3100 this error condition. However, regardless of the exact data type
3101 of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue
3102 the warning, and exit.
3103
3104 There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the
3105 data type of the exported variable:
3106
3107 One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task
3108 of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so
3109 this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature.
3110
3111 A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable --
3112 that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time. For arrays,
3113 there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address)
3114 a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable. Thus:
3115
3116 @example
3117 extern type extern_array[];
3118 extern_array[1] -->
3119 @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @}
3120 @end example
3121
3122 or
3123
3124 @example
3125 extern type extern_array[];
3126 extern_array[1] -->
3127 @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @}
3128 @end example
3129
3130 For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
3131 is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable:
3132
3133 @example
3134 extern struct s extern_struct;
3135 extern_struct.field -->
3136 @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @}
3137 @end example
3138
3139 or
3140
3141 @example
3142 extern long long extern_ll;
3143 extern_ll -->
3144 @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @}
3145 @end example
3146
3147 A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
3148 'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
3149 @code{__declspec(dllimport)}. However, in practice that
3150 requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are
3151 building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or
3152 merely building/linking to a static library. In making the choice
3153 between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
3154 constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage:
3155
3156 Original:
3157 @example
3158 --foo.h
3159 extern int arr[];
3160 --foo.c
3161 #include "foo.h"
3162 void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3163 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3164 @}
3165 @end example
3166
3167 Solution 1:
3168 @example
3169 --foo.h
3170 extern int arr[];
3171 --foo.c
3172 #include "foo.h"
3173 void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3174 /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
3175 volatile int *parr = arr;
3176 printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
3177 @}
3178 @end example
3179
3180 Solution 2:
3181 @example
3182 --foo.h
3183 /* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
3184 #if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
3185 !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
3186 #define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
3187 #else
3188 #define FOO_IMPORT
3189 #endif
3190 extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
3191 --foo.c
3192 #include "foo.h"
3193 void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3194 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3195 @}
3196 @end example
3197
3198 A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your
3199 library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface
3200 for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
3201 functions).
3202
3203 @kindex --disable-auto-import
3204 @item --disable-auto-import
3205 Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to
3206 @code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs.
3207 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3208
3209 @kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3210 @item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3211 If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section,
3212 that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create
3213 a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime
3214 environment to adjust references to such data in your client code.
3215 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3216
3217 @kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3218 @item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3219 Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs.
3220 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3221
3222 @kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug
3223 @item --enable-extra-pe-debug
3224 Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
3225 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3226
3227 @kindex --section-alignment
3228 @item --section-alignment
3229 Sets the section alignment. Sections in memory will always begin at
3230 addresses which are a multiple of this number. Defaults to 0x1000.
3231 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3232
3233 @cindex stack size
3234 @kindex --stack
3235 @item --stack @var{reserve}
3236 @itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit}
3237 Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
3238 to be used as stack for this program. The default is 2MB reserved, 4K
3239 committed.
3240 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3241
3242 @kindex --subsystem
3243 @item --subsystem @var{which}
3244 @itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}
3245 @itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor}
3246 Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute. The
3247 legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows},
3248 @code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}. You may optionally set
3249 the subsystem version also. Numeric values are also accepted for
3250 @var{which}.
3251 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3252
3253 The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field
3254 of the PE file header:
3255 [These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3256
3257 @kindex --high-entropy-va
3258 @item --high-entropy-va
3259 @itemx --disable-high-entropy-va
3260 Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
3261 (ASLR). This option is enabled by default for 64-bit PE images.
3262
3263 This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and
3264 @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
3265
3266 @kindex --dynamicbase
3267 @item --dynamicbase
3268 @itemx --disable-dynamicbase
3269 The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
3270 randomization (ASLR). This feature was introduced with MS Windows
3271 Vista for i386 PE targets. This option is enabled by default but
3272 can be disabled via the @option{--disable-dynamicbase} option.
3273 This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
3274
3275 @kindex --forceinteg
3276 @item --forceinteg
3277 @itemx --disable-forceinteg
3278 Code integrity checks are enforced. This option is disabled by
3279 default.
3280
3281 @kindex --nxcompat
3282 @item --nxcompat
3283 @item --disable-nxcompat
3284 The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.
3285 This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE
3286 targets. The option is enabled by default.
3287
3288 @kindex --no-isolation
3289 @item --no-isolation
3290 @itemx --disable-no-isolation
3291 Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
3292 This option is disabled by default.
3293
3294 @kindex --no-seh
3295 @item --no-seh
3296 @itemx --disable-no-seh
3297 The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from
3298 this image. This option is disabled by default.
3299
3300 @kindex --no-bind
3301 @item --no-bind
3302 @itemx --disable-no-bind
3303 Do not bind this image. This option is disabled by default.
3304
3305 @kindex --wdmdriver
3306 @item --wdmdriver
3307 @itemx --disable-wdmdriver
3308 The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model. This option is disabled
3309 by default.
3310
3311 @kindex --tsaware
3312 @item --tsaware
3313 @itemx --disable-tsaware
3314 The image is Terminal Server aware. This option is disabled by
3315 default.
3316
3317 @kindex --insert-timestamp
3318 @item --insert-timestamp
3319 @itemx --no-insert-timestamp
3320 Insert a real timestamp into the image. This is the default behaviour
3321 as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with
3322 other, proprietary tools. The problem with this default is that it
3323 will result in slightly different images being produced each time the
3324 same sources are linked. The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp}
3325 can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring
3326 that binaries produced from identical sources will compare
3327 identically.
3328
3329 @kindex --enable-reloc-section
3330 @item --enable-reloc-section
3331 @itemx --disable-reloc-section
3332 Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image
3333 is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header.
3334 This option is enabled by default.
3335 @end table
3336
3337 @c man end
3338
3339 @ifset C6X
3340 @subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
3341
3342 @c man begin OPTIONS
3343
3344 The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared
3345 libraries. Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index;
3346 all executables use an index of 0.
3347
3348 @table @gcctabopt
3349
3350 @kindex --dsbt-size
3351 @item --dsbt-size @var{size}
3352 This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable
3353 or shared library to @var{size}. The default is to create a table with 64
3354 entries.
3355
3356 @kindex --dsbt-index
3357 @item --dsbt-index @var{index}
3358 This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library
3359 to @var{index}. The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating
3360 executables. If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the
3361 @code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file.
3362
3363 @kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
3364 The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent
3365 exidx entries in frame unwind info.
3366
3367 @end table
3368
3369 @c man end
3370 @end ifset
3371
3372 @ifset CSKY
3373 @subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets
3374
3375 @c man begin OPTIONS
3376
3377 @table @gcctabopt
3378
3379 @kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY
3380 @item --branch-stub
3381 This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub
3382 sections when needed to extend the range of branches. This option is
3383 usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that
3384 can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by
3385 the compiler or assembler.
3386
3387 @kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY
3388 @item --stub-group-size=@var{N}
3389 This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation.
3390 It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can
3391 be handled by one stub section. A negative value of @var{N} locates
3392 stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub
3393 sections to appear either before or after the branches. Values of
3394 @samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the
3395 linker should choose suitable defaults.
3396
3397 @end table
3398
3399 @c man end
3400 @end ifset
3401
3402 @ifset M68HC11
3403 @subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
3404
3405 @c man begin OPTIONS
3406
3407 The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
3408 memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
3409
3410 @table @gcctabopt
3411
3412 @kindex --no-trampoline
3413 @item --no-trampoline
3414 This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline
3415 is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr}
3416 instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken).
3417
3418 @kindex --bank-window
3419 @item --bank-window @var{name}
3420 This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in
3421 the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window.
3422 The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute
3423 paging and addresses within the memory window.
3424
3425 @end table
3426
3427 @c man end
3428 @end ifset
3429
3430 @ifset M68K
3431 @subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target
3432
3433 @c man begin OPTIONS
3434
3435 The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation
3436 when linking for 68K targets.
3437
3438 @table @gcctabopt
3439
3440 @kindex --got
3441 @item --got=@var{type}
3442 This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
3443 @var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative},
3444 @samp{multigot} or @samp{target}. For more information refer to the
3445 Info entry for @file{ld}.
3446
3447 @end table
3448
3449 @c man end
3450 @end ifset
3451
3452 @ifset MIPS
3453 @subsection Options specific to MIPS targets
3454
3455 @c man begin OPTIONS
3456
3457 The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
3458 generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when
3459 linking for MIPS targets.
3460
3461 @table @gcctabopt
3462
3463 @kindex --insn32
3464 @item --insn32
3465 @kindex --no-insn32
3466 @itemx --no-insn32
3467 These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code
3468 generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs,
3469 or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses
3470 32-bit instruction encodings. By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is
3471 used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where
3472 possible.
3473
3474 @kindex --ignore-branch-isa
3475 @item --ignore-branch-isa
3476 @kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
3477 @itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa
3478 These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode
3479 transitions. If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker
3480 accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required
3481 is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL}
3482 instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to
3483 equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is
3484 calculated. By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used
3485 a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce
3486 an error.
3487
3488 @kindex --compact-branches
3489 @item --compact-branches
3490 @kindex --no-compact-branches
3491 @itemx --no-compact-branches
3492 These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker
3493 in the PLT entries for MIPS R6.
3494
3495 @end table
3496
3497 @c man end
3498 @end ifset
3499
3500
3501 @ifset PDP11
3502 @subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets
3503
3504 @c man begin OPTIONS
3505
3506 For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be
3507 produced as selected by the following options. The default variant
3508 for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other
3509 targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default. The @samp{--imagic} option is
3510 defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described
3511 here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target.
3512
3513 @table @gcctabopt
3514
3515 @kindex -N
3516 @item -N
3517 @kindex --omagic
3518 @itemx --omagic
3519
3520 Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to
3521 indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and
3522 shared. Since the text and data sections are both readable and
3523 writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after
3524 the text segment. This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable
3525 programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems
3526 from the beginning through 2.11BSD.
3527
3528 @kindex -n
3529 @item -n
3530 @kindex --nmagic
3531 @itemx --nmagic
3532
3533 Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to
3534 indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will
3535 be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same
3536 file. This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K
3537 byte page boundary following the end of the text. This option creates
3538 a @emph{pure executable} format.
3539
3540 @kindex -z
3541 @item -z
3542 @kindex --imagic
3543 @itemx --imagic
3544
3545 Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to
3546 indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and
3547 data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split
3548 instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in
3549 larger models of the PDP11. This doubles the address space available
3550 to the program. The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and
3551 shareable. The only difference in the output format between this
3552 option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text
3553 and data sections start at location 0. The @samp{-z} option selected
3554 this format in 2.11BSD. This option creates a @emph{separate
3555 executable} format.
3556
3557 @kindex --no-omagic
3558 @item --no-omagic
3559
3560 Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout.
3561
3562 @end table
3563
3564 @c man end
3565 @end ifset
3566
3567 @ifset UsesEnvVars
3568 @node Environment
3569 @section Environment Variables
3570
3571 @c man begin ENVIRONMENT
3572
3573 You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables
3574 @ifclear SingleFormat
3575 @code{GNUTARGET},
3576 @end ifclear
3577 @code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}.
3578
3579 @ifclear SingleFormat
3580 @kindex GNUTARGET
3581 @cindex default input format
3582 @code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't
3583 use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}). Its value should be one
3584 of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}). If there is no
3585 @code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format
3586 of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD
3587 attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files;
3588 this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since
3589 there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify
3590 object-file formats is unique. However, the configuration procedure for
3591 BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first
3592 in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
3593 @end ifclear
3594
3595 @kindex LDEMULATION
3596 @cindex default emulation
3597 @cindex emulation, default
3598 @code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the
3599 @samp{-m} option. The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
3600 behaviour, particularly the default linker script. You can list the
3601 available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options. If
3602 the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment
3603 variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the
3604 linker was configured.
3605
3606 @kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE
3607 @cindex demangling, default
3608 Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols. However, if
3609 @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will
3610 default to not demangling symbols. This environment variable is used in
3611 a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program. The default
3612 may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle}
3613 options.
3614
3615 @c man end
3616 @end ifset
3617
3618 @node Scripts
3619 @chapter Linker Scripts
3620
3621 @cindex scripts
3622 @cindex linker scripts
3623 @cindex command files
3624 Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}. This script is
3625 written in the linker command language.
3626
3627 The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in
3628 the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control
3629 the memory layout of the output file. Most linker scripts do nothing
3630 more than this. However, when necessary, the linker script can also
3631 direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands
3632 described below.
3633
3634 The linker always uses a linker script. If you do not supply one
3635 yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
3636 linker executable. You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option
3637 to display the default linker script. Certain command-line options,
3638 such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script.
3639
3640 You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command
3641 line option. When you do this, your linker script will replace the
3642 default linker script.
3643
3644 You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files
3645 to the linker, as though they were files to be linked. @xref{Implicit
3646 Linker Scripts}.
3647
3648 @menu
3649 * Basic Script Concepts:: Basic Linker Script Concepts
3650 * Script Format:: Linker Script Format
3651 * Simple Example:: Simple Linker Script Example
3652 * Simple Commands:: Simple Linker Script Commands
3653 * Assignments:: Assigning Values to Symbols
3654 * SECTIONS:: SECTIONS Command
3655 * MEMORY:: MEMORY Command
3656 * PHDRS:: PHDRS Command
3657 * VERSION:: VERSION Command
3658 * Expressions:: Expressions in Linker Scripts
3659 * Implicit Linker Scripts:: Implicit Linker Scripts
3660 @end menu
3661
3662 @node Basic Script Concepts
3663 @section Basic Linker Script Concepts
3664 @cindex linker script concepts
3665 We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
3666 describe the linker script language.
3667
3668 The linker combines input files into a single output file. The output
3669 file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
3670 @dfn{object file format}. Each file is called an @dfn{object file}.
3671 The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our
3672 purposes we will also call it an object file. Each object file has,
3673 among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}. We sometimes refer to a
3674 section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section
3675 in the output file is an @dfn{output section}.
3676
3677 Each section in an object file has a name and a size. Most sections
3678 also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section
3679 contents}. A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that
3680 the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.
3681 A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an
3682 area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be
3683 loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out). A section
3684 which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort
3685 of debugging information.
3686
3687 Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses. The
3688 first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address. This is the address
3689 the section will have when the output file is run. The second is the
3690 @dfn{LMA}, or load memory address. This is the address at which the
3691 section will be loaded. In most cases the two addresses will be the
3692 same. An example of when they might be different is when a data section
3693 is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
3694 (this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
3695 based system). In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
3696 RAM address would be the VMA.
3697
3698 You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump}
3699 program with the @samp{-h} option.
3700
3701 Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the
3702 @dfn{symbol table}. A symbol may be defined or undefined. Each symbol
3703 has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other
3704 information. If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you
3705 will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or
3706 static variable. Every undefined function or global variable which is
3707 referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
3708
3709 You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm}
3710 program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t}
3711 option.
3712
3713 @node Script Format
3714 @section Linker Script Format
3715 @cindex linker script format
3716 Linker scripts are text files.
3717
3718 You write a linker script as a series of commands. Each command is
3719 either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
3720 symbol. You may separate commands using semicolons. Whitespace is
3721 generally ignored.
3722
3723 Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly.
3724 If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would
3725 otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in
3726 double quotes. There is no way to use a double quote character in a
3727 file name.
3728
3729 You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
3730 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/}. As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent
3731 to whitespace.
3732
3733 @node Simple Example
3734 @section Simple Linker Script Example
3735 @cindex linker script example
3736 @cindex example of linker script
3737 Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
3738
3739 The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
3740 @samp{SECTIONS}. You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the
3741 memory layout of the output file.
3742
3743 The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command. Here we will
3744 describe a simple use of it. Let's assume your program consists only of
3745 code, initialized data, and uninitialized data. These will be in the
3746 @samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively.
3747 Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in
3748 your input files.
3749
3750 For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
3751 0x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000. Here is a
3752 linker script which will do that:
3753 @smallexample
3754 SECTIONS
3755 @{
3756 . = 0x10000;
3757 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
3758 . = 0x8000000;
3759 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
3760 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
3761 @}
3762 @end smallexample
3763
3764 You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS},
3765 followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section
3766 descriptions enclosed in curly braces.
3767
3768 The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example
3769 sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location
3770 counter. If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
3771 other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
3772 current value of the location counter. The location counter is then
3773 incremented by the size of the output section. At the start of the
3774 @samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}.
3775
3776 The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}. The colon is
3777 required syntax which may be ignored for now. Within the curly braces
3778 after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
3779 which should be placed into this output section. The @samp{*} is a
3780 wildcard which matches any file name. The expression @samp{*(.text)}
3781 means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files.
3782
3783 Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section
3784 @samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the
3785 @samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}.
3786
3787 The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in
3788 the output file. The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section
3789 at address @samp{0x8000000}. After the linker places the @samp{.data}
3790 output section, the value of the location counter will be
3791 @samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section. The
3792 effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section
3793 immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory.
3794
3795 The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
3796 alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary. In this
3797 example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}
3798 sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker
3799 may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss}
3800 sections.
3801
3802 That's it! That's a simple and complete linker script.
3803
3804 @node Simple Commands
3805 @section Simple Linker Script Commands
3806 @cindex linker script simple commands
3807 In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
3808
3809 @menu
3810 * Entry Point:: Setting the entry point
3811 * File Commands:: Commands dealing with files
3812 @ifclear SingleFormat
3813 * Format Commands:: Commands dealing with object file formats
3814 @end ifclear
3815
3816 * REGION_ALIAS:: Assign alias names to memory regions
3817 * Miscellaneous Commands:: Other linker script commands
3818 @end menu
3819
3820 @node Entry Point
3821 @subsection Setting the Entry Point
3822 @kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3823 @cindex start of execution
3824 @cindex first instruction
3825 @cindex entry point
3826 The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry
3827 point}. You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the
3828 entry point. The argument is a symbol name:
3829 @smallexample
3830 ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3831 @end smallexample
3832
3833 There are several ways to set the entry point. The linker will set the
3834 entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
3835 stopping when one of them succeeds:
3836 @itemize @bullet
3837 @item
3838 the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option;
3839 @item
3840 the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script;
3841 @item
3842 the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined; For many
3843 targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example
3844 check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found.
3845 @item
3846 the address of the first byte of the @samp{.text} section, if present;
3847 @item
3848 The address @code{0}.
3849 @end itemize
3850
3851 @node File Commands
3852 @subsection Commands Dealing with Files
3853 @cindex linker script file commands
3854 Several linker script commands deal with files.
3855
3856 @table @code
3857 @item INCLUDE @var{filename}
3858 @kindex INCLUDE @var{filename}
3859 @cindex including a linker script
3860 Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point. The file will
3861 be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified
3862 with the @option{-L} option. You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to
3863 10 levels deep.
3864
3865 You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or
3866 @code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions.
3867
3868 @item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3869 @itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3870 @kindex INPUT(@var{files})
3871 @cindex input files in linker scripts
3872 @cindex input object files in linker scripts
3873 @cindex linker script input object files
3874 The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files
3875 in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
3876
3877 For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do
3878 a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line,
3879 then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script.
3880
3881 In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker
3882 script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option.
3883
3884 In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts
3885 with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was
3886 located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked
3887 for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}. The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying
3888 @code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the
3889 filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of
3890 @samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
3891
3892 If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open
3893 the file in the directory containing the linker script. If it is not
3894 found the linker will then search the current directory. If it is still
3895 not found the linker will search through the archive library search
3896 path.
3897
3898 If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the
3899 name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument
3900 @samp{-l}.
3901
3902 When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the
3903 files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
3904 script file is included. This can affect archive searching.
3905
3906 @item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3907 @itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3908 @kindex GROUP(@var{files})
3909 @cindex grouping input files
3910 The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named
3911 files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
3912 new undefined references are created. See the description of @samp{-(}
3913 in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
3914
3915 @item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3916 @itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3917 @kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files})
3918 This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP}
3919 commands, among other filenames. The files listed will be handled
3920 as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands,
3921 with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
3922 when they are actually needed. This construct essentially enables
3923 @option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it
3924 and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed}
3925 setting afterwards.
3926
3927 @item OUTPUT(@var{filename})
3928 @kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename})
3929 @cindex output file name in linker script
3930 The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file. Using
3931 @code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using
3932 @samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command
3933 Line Options}). If both are used, the command-line option takes
3934 precedence.
3935
3936 You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the
3937 output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}.
3938
3939 @item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
3940 @kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
3941 @cindex library search path in linker script
3942 @cindex archive search path in linker script
3943 @cindex search path in linker script
3944 The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where
3945 @command{ld} looks for archive libraries. Using
3946 @code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}}
3947 on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both
3948 are used, then the linker will search both paths. Paths specified using
3949 the command-line option are searched first.
3950
3951 @item STARTUP(@var{filename})
3952 @kindex STARTUP(@var{filename})
3953 @cindex first input file
3954 The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except
3955 that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as
3956 though it were specified first on the command line. This may be useful
3957 when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the
3958 first file.
3959 @end table
3960
3961 @ifclear SingleFormat
3962 @node Format Commands
3963 @subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
3964 A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
3965
3966 @table @code
3967 @item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
3968 @itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little})
3969 @kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
3970 @cindex output file format in linker script
3971 The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the
3972 output file (@pxref{BFD}). Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is
3973 exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line
3974 (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both are used, the command
3975 line option takes precedence.
3976
3977 You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different
3978 formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options.
3979 This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
3980 desired endianness.
3981
3982 If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format
3983 will be the first argument, @var{default}. If @samp{-EB} is used, the
3984 output format will be the second argument, @var{big}. If @samp{-EL} is
3985 used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}.
3986
3987 For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this
3988 command:
3989 @smallexample
3990 OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
3991 @end smallexample
3992 This says that the default format for the output file is
3993 @samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line
3994 option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips}
3995 format.
3996
3997 @item TARGET(@var{bfdname})
3998 @kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname})
3999 @cindex input file format in linker script
4000 The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input
4001 files. It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands.
4002 This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line
4003 (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If the @code{TARGET} command
4004 is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET}
4005 command is also used to set the format for the output file. @xref{BFD}.
4006 @end table
4007 @end ifclear
4008
4009 @node REGION_ALIAS
4010 @subsection Assign alias names to memory regions
4011 @kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4012 @cindex region alias
4013 @cindex region names
4014
4015 Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
4016 @ref{MEMORY} command. Each name corresponds to at most one memory region.
4017
4018 @smallexample
4019 REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4020 @end smallexample
4021
4022 The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the
4023 memory region @var{region}. This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
4024 to memory regions. An example follows.
4025
4026 Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various
4027 memory storage devices. All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM}
4028 that allows code execution or data storage. Some may have a read-only,
4029 non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data
4030 access. The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with
4031 read-only data access and no code execution capability. We have four output
4032 sections:
4033
4034 @itemize @bullet
4035 @item
4036 @code{.text} program code;
4037 @item
4038 @code{.rodata} read-only data;
4039 @item
4040 @code{.data} read-write initialized data;
4041 @item
4042 @code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data.
4043 @end itemize
4044
4045 The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent
4046 part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the
4047 output sections to the memory regions available on the system. Our embedded
4048 systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and
4049 @code{C}:
4050 @multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25
4051 @item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C
4052 @item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM
4053 @item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2
4054 @item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2
4055 @item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM
4056 @end multitable
4057 The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is
4058 loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively. Please note that
4059 the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at
4060 the end of the @code{.rodata} section.
4061
4062 The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows. It
4063 includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the
4064 memory layout:
4065 @smallexample
4066 INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
4067
4068 SECTIONS
4069 @{
4070 .text :
4071 @{
4072 *(.text)
4073 @} > REGION_TEXT
4074 .rodata :
4075 @{
4076 *(.rodata)
4077 rodata_end = .;
4078 @} > REGION_RODATA
4079 .data : AT (rodata_end)
4080 @{
4081 data_start = .;
4082 *(.data)
4083 @} > REGION_DATA
4084 data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
4085 data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
4086 .bss :
4087 @{
4088 *(.bss)
4089 @} > REGION_BSS
4090 @}
4091 @end smallexample
4092
4093 Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory
4094 regions and alias names. The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three
4095 variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}:
4096 @table @code
4097 @item A
4098 Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}.
4099 @smallexample
4100 MEMORY
4101 @{
4102 RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
4103 @}
4104
4105 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
4106 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
4107 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4108 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4109 @end smallexample
4110 @item B
4111 Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}. Read-write data goes
4112 into the @code{RAM}. An image of the initialized data is loaded into the
4113 @code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}.
4114 @smallexample
4115 MEMORY
4116 @{
4117 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
4118 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4119 @}
4120
4121 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4122 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
4123 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4124 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4125 @end smallexample
4126 @item C
4127 Program code goes into the @code{ROM}. Read-only data goes into the
4128 @code{ROM2}. Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}. An image of the
4129 initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during
4130 system start into the @code{RAM}.
4131 @smallexample
4132 MEMORY
4133 @{
4134 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
4135 ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4136 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
4137 @}
4138
4139 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4140 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
4141 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4142 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4143 @end smallexample
4144 @end table
4145
4146 It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the
4147 @code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if
4148 necessary:
4149 @smallexample
4150 #include <string.h>
4151
4152 extern char data_start [];
4153 extern char data_size [];
4154 extern char data_load_start [];
4155
4156 void copy_data(void)
4157 @{
4158 if (data_start != data_load_start)
4159 @{
4160 memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
4161 @}
4162 @}
4163 @end smallexample
4164
4165 @node Miscellaneous Commands
4166 @subsection Other Linker Script Commands
4167 There are a few other linker scripts commands.
4168
4169 @table @code
4170 @item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message})
4171 @kindex ASSERT
4172 @cindex assertion in linker script
4173 Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero. If it is zero, then exit the linker
4174 with an error code, and print @var{message}.
4175
4176 Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking
4177 take place. This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd
4178 inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values
4179 for those symbols. The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd
4180 symbols that just reference dot. Thus an assertion like this:
4181
4182 @smallexample
4183 .stack :
4184 @{
4185 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4186 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4187 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4188 @}
4189 @end smallexample
4190
4191 will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere. Symbols
4192 PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they
4193 can be used inside ASSERTions. Thus:
4194
4195 @smallexample
4196 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4197 .stack :
4198 @{
4199 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4200 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4201 @}
4202 @end smallexample
4203
4204 will work.
4205
4206 @item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{})
4207 @kindex EXTERN
4208 @cindex undefined symbol in linker script
4209 Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
4210 symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
4211 modules from standard libraries. You may list several @var{symbol}s for
4212 each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times. This
4213 command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option.
4214
4215 @item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4216 @kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4217 @cindex common allocation in linker script
4218 This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option:
4219 to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
4220 output file is specified (@samp{-r}).
4221
4222 @item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4223 @kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4224 @cindex common allocation in linker script
4225 This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common}
4226 command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses
4227 to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
4228
4229 @item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4230 @kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4231 @cindex group allocation in linker script
4232 @cindex section groups
4233 @cindex COMDAT
4234 This command has the same effect as the
4235 @samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make
4236 @command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections,
4237 and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is
4238 specified (@samp{-r}).
4239
4240 @item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section}
4241 @kindex INSERT
4242 @cindex insert user script into default script
4243 This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to
4244 augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays. It
4245 inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
4246 @var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the
4247 default linker script. The exact insertion point is as for orphan
4248 sections. @xref{Location Counter}. The insertion happens after the
4249 linker has mapped input sections to output sections. Prior to the
4250 insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default
4251 linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the
4252 default linker script statements in the internal linker representation
4253 of the script. In particular, input section assignments will be made
4254 to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script. Here
4255 is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look:
4256
4257 @smallexample
4258 SECTIONS
4259 @{
4260 OVERLAY :
4261 @{
4262 .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @}
4263 .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @}
4264 @}
4265 @}
4266 INSERT AFTER .text;
4267 @end smallexample
4268
4269 @item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{})
4270 @kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections})
4271 @cindex cross references
4272 This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4273 references among certain output sections.
4274
4275 In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
4276 using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section
4277 will not be. Any direct references between the two sections would be
4278 errors. For example, it would be an error if code in one section called
4279 a function defined in the other section.
4280
4281 The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names. If
4282 @command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
4283 an error and returns a non-zero exit status. Note that the
4284 @code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section
4285 names.
4286
4287 @item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{})
4288 @kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections})
4289 @cindex cross references
4290 This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4291 references to one section from a list of other sections.
4292
4293 The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more
4294 output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where
4295 a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application
4296 there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety
4297 must never call back.
4298
4299 The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names.
4300 The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections.
4301 If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of
4302 the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit
4303 status. Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section
4304 names, not input section names.
4305
4306 @ifclear SingleFormat
4307 @item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4308 @kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4309 @cindex machine architecture
4310 @cindex architecture
4311 Specify a particular output machine architecture. The argument is one
4312 of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}). You can see the
4313 architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with
4314 the @samp{-f} option.
4315 @end ifclear
4316
4317 @item LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4318 @kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4319 This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior. If
4320 @var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers
4321 in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere.
4322 @xref{Expression Section}.
4323 @end table
4324
4325 @node Assignments
4326 @section Assigning Values to Symbols
4327 @cindex assignment in scripts
4328 @cindex symbol definition, scripts
4329 @cindex variables, defining
4330 You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script. This will define
4331 the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
4332
4333 @menu
4334 * Simple Assignments:: Simple Assignments
4335 * HIDDEN:: HIDDEN
4336 * PROVIDE:: PROVIDE
4337 * PROVIDE_HIDDEN:: PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4338 * Source Code Reference:: How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
4339 @end menu
4340
4341 @node Simple Assignments
4342 @subsection Simple Assignments
4343
4344 You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
4345
4346 @table @code
4347 @item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ;
4348 @itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ;
4349 @itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ;
4350 @itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ;
4351 @itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ;
4352 @itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ;
4353 @itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ;
4354 @itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ;
4355 @itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ;
4356 @end table
4357
4358 The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of
4359 @var{expression}. In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be
4360 defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly.
4361
4362 The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter. You
4363 may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command. @xref{Location Counter}.
4364
4365 The semicolon after @var{expression} is required.
4366
4367 Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}.
4368
4369 You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as
4370 statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output
4371 section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command.
4372
4373 The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
4374 expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}.
4375
4376 Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
4377 assignments may be used:
4378
4379 @smallexample
4380 floating_point = 0;
4381 SECTIONS
4382 @{
4383 .text :
4384 @{
4385 *(.text)
4386 _etext = .;
4387 @}
4388 _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
4389 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4390 @}
4391 @end smallexample
4392 @noindent
4393 In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as
4394 zero. The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following
4395 the last @samp{.text} input section. The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be
4396 defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned
4397 upward to a 4 byte boundary.
4398
4399 @node HIDDEN
4400 @subsection HIDDEN
4401 @cindex HIDDEN
4402 For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
4403 exported. The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4404
4405 Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use
4406 @code{HIDDEN}:
4407
4408 @smallexample
4409 HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
4410 SECTIONS
4411 @{
4412 .text :
4413 @{
4414 *(.text)
4415 HIDDEN(_etext = .);
4416 @}
4417 HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
4418 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4419 @}
4420 @end smallexample
4421 @noindent
4422 In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module.
4423
4424 @node PROVIDE
4425 @subsection PROVIDE
4426 @cindex PROVIDE
4427 In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
4428 only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
4429 the link. For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol
4430 @samp{etext}. However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use
4431 @samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error. The
4432 @code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as
4433 @samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined. The syntax is
4434 @code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4435
4436 Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}:
4437 @smallexample
4438 SECTIONS
4439 @{
4440 .text :
4441 @{
4442 *(.text)
4443 _etext = .;
4444 PROVIDE(etext = .);
4445 @}
4446 @}
4447 @end smallexample
4448
4449 In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading
4450 underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition error. If, on
4451 the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading
4452 underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
4453 If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the
4454 linker will use the definition in the linker script.
4455
4456 Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be
4457 defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol
4458 that the @code{PROVIDE} would create. This is particularly important
4459 when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as
4460 @samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols.
4461
4462 @node PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4463 @subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4464 @cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4465 Similar to @code{PROVIDE}. For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
4466 hidden and won't be exported.
4467
4468 @node Source Code Reference
4469 @subsection Source Code Reference
4470
4471 Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
4472 intuitive. In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to
4473 a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a
4474 symbol that does not have a value.
4475
4476 Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
4477 transform names in the source code into different names when they are
4478 stored in the symbol table. For example, Fortran compilers commonly
4479 prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name
4480 mangling}. Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name
4481 of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
4482 variable as it is defined in a linker script. For example in C a
4483 linker script variable might be referred to as:
4484
4485 @smallexample
4486 extern int foo;
4487 @end smallexample
4488
4489 But in the linker script it might be defined as:
4490
4491 @smallexample
4492 _foo = 1000;
4493 @end smallexample
4494
4495 In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
4496 transformation has taken place.
4497
4498 When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
4499 things happen. The first is that the compiler reserves enough space
4500 in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol. The
4501 second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol
4502 table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}. ie the symbol table
4503 contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's
4504 value. So for example the following C declaration, at file scope:
4505
4506 @smallexample
4507 int foo = 1000;
4508 @end smallexample
4509
4510 creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table. This entry
4511 holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the
4512 number 1000 is initially stored.
4513
4514 When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
4515 first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
4516 memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
4517 So:
4518
4519 @smallexample
4520 foo = 1;
4521 @end smallexample
4522
4523 looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address
4524 associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
4525 address. Whereas:
4526
4527 @smallexample
4528 int * a = & foo;
4529 @end smallexample
4530
4531 looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address
4532 and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with
4533 the variable @samp{a}.
4534
4535 Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
4536 the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them. Thus they are
4537 an address without a value. So for example the linker script definition:
4538
4539 @smallexample
4540 foo = 1000;
4541 @end smallexample
4542
4543 creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds
4544 the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
4545 address 1000. This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a
4546 linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
4547 access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol.
4548
4549 Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code
4550 you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to
4551 use its value. For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a
4552 section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the
4553 linker script contains these declarations:
4554
4555 @smallexample
4556 @group
4557 start_of_ROM = .ROM;
4558 end_of_ROM = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM);
4559 start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
4560 @end group
4561 @end smallexample
4562
4563 Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
4564
4565 @smallexample
4566 @group
4567 extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
4568
4569 memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
4570 @end group
4571 @end smallexample
4572
4573 Note the use of the @samp{&} operators. These are correct.
4574 Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or
4575 arrays and then the code will again work as expected:
4576
4577 @smallexample
4578 @group
4579 extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[];
4580
4581 memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM);
4582 @end group
4583 @end smallexample
4584
4585 Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&}
4586 operators.
4587
4588 @node SECTIONS
4589 @section SECTIONS Command
4590 @kindex SECTIONS
4591 The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections
4592 into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
4593
4594 The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is:
4595 @smallexample
4596 SECTIONS
4597 @{
4598 @var{sections-command}
4599 @var{sections-command}
4600 @dots{}
4601 @}
4602 @end smallexample
4603
4604 Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following:
4605
4606 @itemize @bullet
4607 @item
4608 an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command})
4609 @item
4610 a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4611 @item
4612 an output section description
4613 @item
4614 an overlay description
4615 @end itemize
4616
4617 The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
4618 @code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in
4619 those commands. This can also make the linker script easier to
4620 understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
4621 the layout of the output file.
4622
4623 Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
4624 below.
4625
4626 If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the
4627 linker will place each input section into an identically named output
4628 section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
4629 input files. If all input sections are present in the first file, for
4630 example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
4631 in the first input file. The first section will be at address zero.
4632
4633 @menu
4634 * Output Section Description:: Output section description
4635 * Output Section Name:: Output section name
4636 * Output Section Address:: Output section address
4637 * Input Section:: Input section description
4638 * Output Section Data:: Output section data
4639 * Output Section Keywords:: Output section keywords
4640 * Output Section Discarding:: Output section discarding
4641 * Output Section Attributes:: Output section attributes
4642 * Overlay Description:: Overlay description
4643 @end menu
4644
4645 @node Output Section Description
4646 @subsection Output Section Description
4647 The full description of an output section looks like this:
4648 @smallexample
4649 @group
4650 @var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
4651 [AT(@var{lma})]
4652 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
4653 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
4654 [@var{constraint}]
4655 @{
4656 @var{output-section-command}
4657 @var{output-section-command}
4658 @dots{}
4659 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,]
4660 @end group
4661 @end smallexample
4662
4663 Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes.
4664
4665 The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section
4666 name is unambiguous. The colon and the curly braces are also required.
4667 The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and
4668 the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
4669 The line breaks and other white space are optional.
4670
4671 Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following:
4672
4673 @itemize @bullet
4674 @item
4675 a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4676 @item
4677 an input section description (@pxref{Input Section})
4678 @item
4679 data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data})
4680 @item
4681 a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords})
4682 @end itemize
4683
4684 @node Output Section Name
4685 @subsection Output Section Name
4686 @cindex name, section
4687 @cindex section name
4688 The name of the output section is @var{section}. @var{section} must
4689 meet the constraints of your output format. In formats which only
4690 support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name
4691 must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for
4692 example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the
4693 output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not
4694 names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a
4695 quoted numeric string. A section name may consist of any sequence of
4696 characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as
4697 commas must be quoted.
4698
4699 The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section
4700 Discarding}.
4701
4702 @node Output Section Address
4703 @subsection Output Section Address
4704 @cindex address, section
4705 @cindex section address
4706 The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory
4707 address) of the output section. This address is optional, but if it
4708 is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
4709
4710 If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the
4711 section, based on the heuristic below. This address will be adjusted
4712 to fit the alignment requirement of the output section. The
4713 alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
4714 contained within the output section.
4715
4716 The output section address heuristic is as follows:
4717
4718 @itemize @bullet
4719 @item
4720 If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it
4721 is added to this region and its address will be the next free address
4722 in that region.
4723
4724 @item
4725 If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
4726 regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the
4727 section is selected to contain it. The section's output address will
4728 be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}.
4729
4730 @item
4731 If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
4732 the output address will be based on the current value of the location
4733 counter.
4734 @end itemize
4735
4736 @noindent
4737 For example:
4738
4739 @smallexample
4740 .text . : @{ *(.text) @}
4741 @end smallexample
4742
4743 @noindent
4744 and
4745
4746 @smallexample
4747 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
4748 @end smallexample
4749
4750 @noindent
4751 are subtly different. The first will set the address of the
4752 @samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location
4753 counter. The second will set it to the current value of the location
4754 counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text}
4755 input sections.
4756
4757 The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}.
4758 For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
4759 so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
4760 do something like this:
4761 @smallexample
4762 .text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @}
4763 @end smallexample
4764 @noindent
4765 This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter
4766 aligned upward to the specified value.
4767
4768 Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the
4769 location counter, provided that the section is non-empty. (Empty
4770 sections are ignored).
4771
4772 @node Input Section
4773 @subsection Input Section Description
4774 @cindex input sections
4775 @cindex mapping input sections to output sections
4776 The most common output section command is an input section description.
4777
4778 The input section description is the most basic linker script operation.
4779 You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program
4780 in memory. You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to
4781 map the input files into your memory layout.
4782
4783 @menu
4784 * Input Section Basics:: Input section basics
4785 * Input Section Wildcards:: Input section wildcard patterns
4786 * Input Section Common:: Input section for common symbols
4787 * Input Section Keep:: Input section and garbage collection
4788 * Input Section Example:: Input section example
4789 @end menu
4790
4791 @node Input Section Basics
4792 @subsubsection Input Section Basics
4793 @cindex input section basics
4794 An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
4795 by a list of section names in parentheses.
4796
4797 The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
4798 describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}).
4799
4800 The most common input section description is to include all input
4801 sections with a particular name in the output section. For example, to
4802 include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write:
4803 @smallexample
4804 *(.text)
4805 @end smallexample
4806 @noindent
4807 Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name. To exclude a list
4808 @cindex EXCLUDE_FILE
4809 of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to
4810 match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list. For
4811 example:
4812 @smallexample
4813 EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors)
4814 @end smallexample
4815 @noindent
4816 will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o}
4817 and @file{otherfile.o} to be included. The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be
4818 placed inside the section list, for example:
4819 @smallexample
4820 *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
4821 @end smallexample
4822 @noindent
4823 The result of this is identically to the previous example. Supporting
4824 two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains
4825 more than one section, as described below.
4826
4827 There are two ways to include more than one section:
4828 @smallexample
4829 *(.text .rdata)
4830 *(.text) *(.rdata)
4831 @end smallexample
4832 @noindent
4833 The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and
4834 @samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section. In the
4835 first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
4836 they are found in the linker input. In the second example, all
4837 @samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all
4838 @samp{.rdata} input sections.
4839
4840 When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion
4841 is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the
4842 immediately following section, for example:
4843 @smallexample
4844 *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata)
4845 @end smallexample
4846 @noindent
4847 will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except
4848 @file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections
4849 from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included. To
4850 exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example
4851 could be modified to:
4852 @smallexample
4853 *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata)
4854 @end smallexample
4855 @noindent
4856 Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list,
4857 before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for
4858 all sections. Thus the previous example can be rewritten as:
4859 @smallexample
4860 EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata)
4861 @end smallexample
4862
4863 You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file.
4864 You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that
4865 needs to be at a particular location in memory. For example:
4866 @smallexample
4867 data.o(.data)
4868 @end smallexample
4869
4870 To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
4871 of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
4872
4873 Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections:
4874
4875 @smallexample
4876 @group
4877 SECTIONS @{
4878 .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @}
4879 .text2 : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @}
4880 @}
4881 @end group
4882 @end smallexample
4883
4884 In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any
4885 input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
4886 @code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set. The output section
4887 @samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text)
4888 whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear.
4889
4890 You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
4891 matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file,
4892 with no whitespace around the colon.
4893
4894 @table @samp
4895 @item archive:file
4896 matches file within archive
4897 @item archive:
4898 matches the whole archive
4899 @item :file
4900 matches file but not one in an archive
4901 @end table
4902
4903 Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell
4904 wildcards. On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
4905 single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so
4906 @samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o}
4907 within an archive called @samp{c}. @samp{archive:file} filespecs may
4908 also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in
4909 other linker script contexts. For instance, you cannot extract a file
4910 from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT}
4911 command.
4912
4913 If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in
4914 the input file will be included in the output section. This is not
4915 commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion. For example:
4916 @smallexample
4917 data.o
4918 @end smallexample
4919
4920 When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier
4921 and does not contain any wild card
4922 characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file
4923 name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. If you
4924 did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as
4925 though it appeared on the command line. Note that this differs from an
4926 @code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in
4927 the archive search path.
4928
4929 @node Input Section Wildcards
4930 @subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns
4931 @cindex input section wildcards
4932 @cindex wildcard file name patterns
4933 @cindex file name wildcard patterns
4934 @cindex section name wildcard patterns
4935 In an input section description, either the file name or the section
4936 name or both may be wildcard patterns.
4937
4938 The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
4939 pattern for the file name.
4940
4941 The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
4942
4943 @table @samp
4944 @item *
4945 matches any number of characters
4946 @item ?
4947 matches any single character
4948 @item [@var{chars}]
4949 matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-}
4950 character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in
4951 @samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter
4952 @item \
4953 quotes the following character
4954 @end table
4955
4956 When a file name is matched with a wildcard, the wildcard characters
4957 will not match a @samp{/} character (used to separate directory names on
4958 Unix). A pattern consisting of a single @samp{*} character is an
4959 exception; it will always match any file name, whether it contains a
4960 @samp{/} or not. In a section name, the wildcard characters will match
4961 a @samp{/} character.
4962
4963 File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
4964 specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. The linker
4965 does not search directories to expand wildcards.
4966
4967 If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name
4968 appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker
4969 will use the first match in the linker script. For example, this
4970 sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
4971 @file{data.o} rule will not be used:
4972 @smallexample
4973 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4974 .data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @}
4975 @end smallexample
4976
4977 @cindex SORT_BY_NAME
4978 Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards
4979 in the order in which they are seen during the link. You can change
4980 this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard
4981 pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}). When the
4982 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections
4983 into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file.
4984
4985 @cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT
4986 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4987 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of
4988 alignment before placing them in the output file. Placing larger
4989 alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding
4990 needed.
4991
4992 @cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY
4993 @code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4994 @code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending
4995 numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the
4996 section name before placing them in the output file. In
4997 @code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is
4998 the init_priority. In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN},
4999 @code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority.
5000
5001 @cindex SORT
5002 @code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5003
5004 When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there
5005 can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
5006
5007 @enumerate
5008 @item
5009 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
5010 It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two
5011 sections have the same name.
5012 @item
5013 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
5014 It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two
5015 sections have the same alignment.
5016 @item
5017 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is
5018 treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern).
5019 @item
5020 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern))
5021 is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern).
5022 @item
5023 All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
5024 @end enumerate
5025
5026 When both command-line section sorting option and linker script
5027 section sorting command are used, section sorting command always
5028 takes precedence over the command-line option.
5029
5030 If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
5031 command-line option will make the section sorting command to be
5032 treated as nested sorting command.
5033
5034 @enumerate
5035 @item
5036 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with
5037 @option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to
5038 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
5039 @item
5040 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with
5041 @option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to
5042 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
5043 @end enumerate
5044
5045 If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
5046 command-line option will be ignored.
5047
5048 @cindex SORT_NONE
5049 @code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line
5050 section sorting option.
5051
5052 If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the
5053 @samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file. The map file shows
5054 precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
5055
5056 This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
5057 files. This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text}
5058 sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}.
5059 The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning
5060 with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the
5061 linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}.
5062 @smallexample
5063 @group
5064 SECTIONS @{
5065 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
5066 .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @}
5067 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5068 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
5069 @}
5070 @end group
5071 @end smallexample
5072
5073 @node Input Section Common
5074 @subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols
5075 @cindex common symbol placement
5076 @cindex uninitialized data placement
5077 A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
5078 file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section. The
5079 linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
5080 named @samp{COMMON}.
5081
5082 You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any
5083 other input sections. You can use this to place common symbols from a
5084 particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
5085 input files are placed in another section.
5086
5087 In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
5088 @samp{.bss} section in the output file. For example:
5089 @smallexample
5090 .bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @}
5091 @end smallexample
5092
5093 @cindex scommon section
5094 @cindex small common symbols
5095 Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol. For
5096 example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common
5097 symbols and small common symbols. In this case, the linker will use a
5098 different special section name for other types of common symbols. In
5099 the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common
5100 symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols. This permits you
5101 to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
5102 locations.
5103
5104 @cindex [COMMON]
5105 You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts. This
5106 notation is now considered obsolete. It is equivalent to
5107 @samp{*(COMMON)}.
5108
5109 @node Input Section Keep
5110 @subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection
5111 @cindex KEEP
5112 @cindex garbage collection
5113 When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}),
5114 it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.
5115 This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry
5116 with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or
5117 @code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}.
5118
5119 @node Input Section Example
5120 @subsubsection Input Section Example
5121 The following example is a complete linker script. It tells the linker
5122 to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the
5123 start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location
5124 @samp{0x10000}. All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o}
5125 follows immediately, in the same output section. All of section
5126 @samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section
5127 @samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}.
5128 All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any
5129 files are written to output section @samp{outputc}.
5130
5131 @smallexample
5132 @group
5133 SECTIONS @{
5134 outputa 0x10000 :
5135 @{
5136 all.o
5137 foo.o (.input1)
5138 @}
5139 @end group
5140 @group
5141 outputb :
5142 @{
5143 foo.o (.input2)
5144 foo1.o (.input1)
5145 @}
5146 @end group
5147 @group
5148 outputc :
5149 @{
5150 *(.input1)
5151 *(.input2)
5152 @}
5153 @}
5154 @end group
5155 @end smallexample
5156
5157 If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name
5158 and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will
5159 automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and
5160 __stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section. These
5161 indicate the start address and end address of the output section
5162 respectively. Note: most section names are not representable as
5163 C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character.
5164
5165 @node Output Section Data
5166 @subsection Output Section Data
5167 @cindex data
5168 @cindex section data
5169 @cindex output section data
5170 @kindex BYTE(@var{expression})
5171 @kindex SHORT(@var{expression})
5172 @kindex LONG(@var{expression})
5173 @kindex QUAD(@var{expression})
5174 @kindex SQUAD(@var{expression})
5175 You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
5176 @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as
5177 an output section command. Each keyword is followed by an expression in
5178 parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}). The
5179 value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location
5180 counter.
5181
5182 The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands
5183 store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively). After storing the
5184 bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes
5185 stored.
5186
5187 For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value
5188 of the symbol @samp{addr}:
5189 @smallexample
5190 BYTE(1)
5191 LONG(addr)
5192 @end smallexample
5193
5194 When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the
5195 same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value. When both host and
5196 target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits. In this case
5197 @code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and
5198 @code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
5199
5200 If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness,
5201 which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness.
5202 When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is
5203 true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the
5204 endianness of the first input object file.
5205
5206 Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not
5207 between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
5208 @smallexample
5209 SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5210 @end smallexample
5211 whereas this will work:
5212 @smallexample
5213 SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5214 @end smallexample
5215
5216 @kindex FILL(@var{expression})
5217 @cindex holes, filling
5218 @cindex unspecified memory
5219 You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the
5220 current section. It is followed by an expression in parentheses. Any
5221 otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
5222 gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
5223 with the value of the expression, repeated as
5224 necessary. A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the
5225 point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more
5226 than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in
5227 different parts of an output section.
5228
5229 This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
5230 value @samp{0x90}:
5231 @smallexample
5232 FILL(0x90909090)
5233 @end smallexample
5234
5235 The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output
5236 section attribute, but it only affects the
5237 part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the
5238 entire section. If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes
5239 precedence. @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill
5240 expression.
5241
5242 @node Output Section Keywords
5243 @subsection Output Section Keywords
5244 There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
5245 commands.
5246
5247 @table @code
5248 @kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5249 @cindex input filename symbols
5250 @cindex filename symbols
5251 @item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5252 The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file.
5253 The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input
5254 file. The section of each symbol will be the output section in which
5255 the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears.
5256
5257 This is conventional for the a.out object file format. It is not
5258 normally used for any other object file format.
5259
5260 @kindex CONSTRUCTORS
5261 @cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link
5262 @cindex constructors, arranging in link
5263 @item CONSTRUCTORS
5264 When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
5265 unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
5266 destructors. When linking object file formats which do not support
5267 arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
5268 automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name.
5269 For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the
5270 linker to place constructor information in the output section where the
5271 @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears. The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is
5272 ignored for other object file formats.
5273
5274 The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global
5275 constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end.
5276 Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark
5277 the start and end of the global destructors. The
5278 first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address
5279 of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word. The
5280 compiler must arrange to actually run the code. For these object file
5281 formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine
5282 @code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into
5283 the startup code for @code{main}. @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs
5284 destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function
5285 @code{exit}.
5286
5287 For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support
5288 arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the
5289 addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors}
5290 and @code{.dtors} sections. Placing the following sequence into your
5291 linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++
5292 runtime code expects to see.
5293
5294 @smallexample
5295 __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
5296 LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5297 *(.ctors)
5298 LONG(0)
5299 __CTOR_END__ = .;
5300 __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
5301 LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5302 *(.dtors)
5303 LONG(0)
5304 __DTOR_END__ = .;
5305 @end smallexample
5306
5307 If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority,
5308 which provides some control over the order in which global constructors
5309 are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they
5310 are executed in the correct order. When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS}
5311 command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead. When using the
5312 @code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and
5313 @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and
5314 @samp{*(.dtors)}.
5315
5316 Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically,
5317 and you will not need to concern yourself with them. However, you may
5318 need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker
5319 scripts.
5320
5321 @end table
5322
5323 @node Output Section Discarding
5324 @subsection Output Section Discarding
5325 @cindex discarding sections
5326 @cindex sections, discarding
5327 @cindex removing sections
5328 The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
5329 This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
5330 may not be present in any of the input files. For example:
5331 @smallexample
5332 .foo : @{ *(.foo) @}
5333 @end smallexample
5334 @noindent
5335 will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a
5336 @samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input
5337 sections are not all empty. Other link script directives that allocate
5338 space in an output section will also create the output section. So
5339 too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create
5340 space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym},
5341 @samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when
5342 @samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script.
5343 This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}.
5344
5345 The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address})
5346 on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines
5347 symbols in the output section. In that case the linker will obey
5348 the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
5349 section is discarded.
5350
5351 @cindex /DISCARD/
5352 The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard
5353 input sections. Any input sections which are assigned to an output
5354 section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file.
5355
5356 This can be used to discard input sections marked with the ELF flag
5357 @code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN}, which would otherwise have been saved from linker
5358 garbage collection.
5359
5360 Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be
5361 discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other
5362 members which are not being discarded. This is deliberate.
5363 Discarding takes precedence over grouping.
5364
5365 @node Output Section Attributes
5366 @subsection Output Section Attributes
5367 @cindex output section attributes
5368 We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
5369 like this:
5370
5371 @smallexample
5372 @group
5373 @var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
5374 [AT(@var{lma})]
5375 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
5376 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
5377 [@var{constraint}]
5378 @{
5379 @var{output-section-command}
5380 @var{output-section-command}
5381 @dots{}
5382 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}]
5383 @end group
5384 @end smallexample
5385
5386 We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and
5387 @var{output-section-command}. In this section we will describe the
5388 remaining section attributes.
5389
5390 @menu
5391 * Output Section Type:: Output section type
5392 * Output Section LMA:: Output section LMA
5393 * Forced Output Alignment:: Forced Output Alignment
5394 * Forced Input Alignment:: Forced Input Alignment
5395 * Output Section Constraint:: Output section constraint
5396 * Output Section Region:: Output section region
5397 * Output Section Phdr:: Output section phdr
5398 * Output Section Fill:: Output section fill
5399 @end menu
5400
5401 @node Output Section Type
5402 @subsubsection Output Section Type
5403 Each output section may have a type. The type is a keyword in
5404 parentheses. The following types are defined:
5405
5406 @table @code
5407 @item NOLOAD
5408 The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be
5409 loaded into memory when the program is run.
5410 @item DSECT
5411 @itemx COPY
5412 @itemx INFO
5413 @itemx OVERLAY
5414 These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
5415 rarely used. They all have the same effect: the section should be
5416 marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
5417 section when the program is run.
5418 @end table
5419
5420 @kindex NOLOAD
5421 @cindex prevent unnecessary loading
5422 @cindex loading, preventing
5423 The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
5424 the input sections which map into it. You can override this by using
5425 the section type. For example, in the script sample below, the
5426 @samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not
5427 need to be loaded when the program is run.
5428 @smallexample
5429 @group
5430 SECTIONS @{
5431 ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @}
5432 @dots{}
5433 @}
5434 @end group
5435 @end smallexample
5436
5437 @node Output Section LMA
5438 @subsubsection Output Section LMA
5439 @kindex AT>@var{lma_region}
5440 @kindex AT(@var{lma})
5441 @cindex load address
5442 @cindex section load address
5443 Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
5444 @ref{Basic Script Concepts}. The virtual address is specified by the
5445 @pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier. The load address is
5446 specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords. Specifying a load
5447 address is optional.
5448
5449 The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument. This
5450 specifies the exact load address of the section. The @code{AT>} keyword
5451 takes the name of a memory region as an argument. @xref{MEMORY}. The
5452 load address of the section is set to the next free address in the
5453 region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
5454
5455 If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable
5456 section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the
5457 load address:
5458
5459 @itemize @bullet
5460 @item
5461 If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
5462 the LMA address as well.
5463
5464 @item
5465 If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
5466
5467 @item
5468 Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible
5469 with the current section, and this region contains at least one
5470 section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the
5471 VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of
5472 the last section in the located region.
5473
5474 @item
5475 If no memory regions have been declared then a default region
5476 that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
5477
5478 @item
5479 If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
5480 section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
5481 @end itemize
5482
5483 @cindex ROM initialized data
5484 @cindex initialized data in ROM
5485 This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image. For
5486 example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
5487 called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called
5488 @samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section
5489 even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold
5490 uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}. The symbol @code{_data} is
5491 defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location
5492 counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
5493
5494 @smallexample
5495 @group
5496 SECTIONS
5497 @{
5498 .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @}
5499 .mdata 0x2000 :
5500 AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
5501 @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ; @}
5502 .bss 0x3000 :
5503 @{ _bstart = . ; *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@}
5504 @}
5505 @end group
5506 @end smallexample
5507
5508 The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with
5509 this linker script would include something like the following, to copy
5510 the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address. Notice
5511 how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker
5512 script.
5513
5514 @smallexample
5515 @group
5516 extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
5517 char *src = &_etext;
5518 char *dst = &_data;
5519
5520 /* ROM has data at end of text; copy it. */
5521 while (dst < &_edata)
5522 *dst++ = *src++;
5523
5524 /* Zero bss. */
5525 for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
5526 *dst = 0;
5527 @end group
5528 @end smallexample
5529
5530 @node Forced Output Alignment
5531 @subsubsection Forced Output Alignment
5532 @kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align})
5533 @cindex forcing output section alignment
5534 @cindex output section alignment
5535 You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN. As an
5536 alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains
5537 intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute.
5538
5539 @node Forced Input Alignment
5540 @subsubsection Forced Input Alignment
5541 @kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})
5542 @cindex forcing input section alignment
5543 @cindex input section alignment
5544 You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
5545 SUBALIGN. The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
5546 sections, whether larger or smaller.
5547
5548 @node Output Section Constraint
5549 @subsubsection Output Section Constraint
5550 @kindex ONLY_IF_RO
5551 @kindex ONLY_IF_RW
5552 @cindex constraints on output sections
5553 You can specify that an output section should only be created if all
5554 of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
5555 read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and
5556 @code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively.
5557
5558 @node Output Section Region
5559 @subsubsection Output Section Region
5560 @kindex >@var{region}
5561 @cindex section, assigning to memory region
5562 @cindex memory regions and sections
5563 You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
5564 using @samp{>@var{region}}. @xref{MEMORY}.
5565
5566 Here is a simple example:
5567 @smallexample
5568 @group
5569 MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @}
5570 SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @}
5571 @end group
5572 @end smallexample
5573
5574 @node Output Section Phdr
5575 @subsubsection Output Section Phdr
5576 @kindex :@var{phdr}
5577 @cindex section, assigning to program header
5578 @cindex program headers and sections
5579 You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
5580 using @samp{:@var{phdr}}. @xref{PHDRS}. If a section is assigned to
5581 one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be
5582 assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly
5583 @code{:@var{phdr}} modifier. You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the
5584 linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
5585
5586 Here is a simple example:
5587 @smallexample
5588 @group
5589 PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @}
5590 SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @}
5591 @end group
5592 @end smallexample
5593
5594 @node Output Section Fill
5595 @subsubsection Output Section Fill
5596 @kindex =@var{fillexp}
5597 @cindex section fill pattern
5598 @cindex fill pattern, entire section
5599 You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using
5600 @samp{=@var{fillexp}}. @var{fillexp} is an expression
5601 (@pxref{Expressions}). Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory
5602 within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required
5603 alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as
5604 necessary. If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string
5605 of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then
5606 an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the
5607 fill pattern; Leading zeros become part of the pattern too. For all
5608 other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill
5609 pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the
5610 expression. In all cases, the number is big-endian.
5611
5612 You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the
5613 output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}).
5614
5615 Here is a simple example:
5616 @smallexample
5617 @group
5618 SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @}
5619 @end group
5620 @end smallexample
5621
5622 @node Overlay Description
5623 @subsection Overlay Description
5624 @kindex OVERLAY
5625 @cindex overlays
5626 An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
5627 are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
5628 the same memory address. At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
5629 copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
5630 required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits. This approach
5631 can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
5632 than another.
5633
5634 Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command. The
5635 @code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an
5636 output section description. The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY}
5637 command is as follows:
5638 @smallexample
5639 @group
5640 OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )]
5641 @{
5642 @var{secname1}
5643 @{
5644 @var{output-section-command}
5645 @var{output-section-command}
5646 @dots{}
5647 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5648 @var{secname2}
5649 @{
5650 @var{output-section-command}
5651 @var{output-section-command}
5652 @dots{}
5653 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5654 @dots{}
5655 @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,]
5656 @end group
5657 @end smallexample
5658
5659 Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each
5660 section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above). The
5661 section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to
5662 those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}),
5663 except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for
5664 sections within an @code{OVERLAY}.
5665
5666 The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and
5667 the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
5668
5669 The sections are all defined with the same starting address. The load
5670 addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in
5671 memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a
5672 whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional,
5673 and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional,
5674 and defaults to the current value of the location counter).
5675
5676 If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any
5677 references among the sections, the linker will report an error. Since
5678 the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make
5679 sense for one section to refer directly to another.
5680 @xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}.
5681
5682 For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically
5683 provides two symbols. The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is
5684 defined as the starting load address of the section. The symbol
5685 @code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of
5686 the section. Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal
5687 within C identifiers are removed. C (or assembler) code may use these
5688 symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
5689
5690 At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to
5691 the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section.
5692
5693 Here is an example. Remember that this would appear inside a
5694 @code{SECTIONS} construct.
5695 @smallexample
5696 @group
5697 OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
5698 @{
5699 .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5700 .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5701 @}
5702 @end group
5703 @end smallexample
5704 @noindent
5705 This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at
5706 address 0x1000. @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and
5707 @samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}. The
5708 following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0},
5709 @code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1},
5710 @code{__load_stop_text1}.
5711
5712 C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look
5713 like the following.
5714
5715 @smallexample
5716 @group
5717 extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
5718 memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
5719 &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
5720 @end group
5721 @end smallexample
5722
5723 Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since
5724 everything it does can be done using the more basic commands. The above
5725 example could have been written identically as follows.
5726
5727 @smallexample
5728 @group
5729 .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5730 PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
5731 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
5732 .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5733 PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
5734 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
5735 . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
5736 @end group
5737 @end smallexample
5738
5739 @node MEMORY
5740 @section MEMORY Command
5741 @kindex MEMORY
5742 @cindex memory regions
5743 @cindex regions of memory
5744 @cindex allocating memory
5745 @cindex discontinuous memory
5746 The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
5747 memory. You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command.
5748
5749 The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of
5750 memory in the target. You can use it to describe which memory regions
5751 may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid. You
5752 can then assign sections to particular memory regions. The linker will
5753 set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
5754 regions that become too full. The linker will not shuffle sections
5755 around to fit into the available regions.
5756
5757 A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command,
5758 however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were
5759 specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command. The syntax for
5760 @code{MEMORY} is:
5761 @smallexample
5762 @group
5763 MEMORY
5764 @{
5765 @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len}
5766 @dots{}
5767 @}
5768 @end group
5769 @end smallexample
5770
5771 The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the
5772 region. The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.
5773 Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5774 with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each memory region
5775 must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command. However you can
5776 add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS}
5777 command.
5778
5779 @cindex memory region attributes
5780 The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify
5781 whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
5782 not explicitly mapped in the linker script. As described in
5783 @ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input
5784 section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
5785 the input section. If you define region attributes, the linker will use
5786 them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
5787
5788 The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters:
5789 @table @samp
5790 @item R
5791 Read-only section
5792 @item W
5793 Read/write section
5794 @item X
5795 Executable section
5796 @item A
5797 Allocatable section
5798 @item I
5799 Initialized section
5800 @item L
5801 Same as @samp{I}
5802 @item !
5803 Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
5804 @end table
5805
5806 If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
5807 @samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region. The @samp{!}
5808 attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an
5809 unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does
5810 not match any of the attributes listed afterwards. Thus an attribute
5811 string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either
5812 or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as
5813 the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute.
5814
5815 @kindex ORIGIN =
5816 @kindex o =
5817 @kindex org =
5818 The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of
5819 the memory region. The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
5820 cannot involve any symbols. The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be
5821 abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example,
5822 @code{ORG}).
5823
5824 @kindex LENGTH =
5825 @kindex len =
5826 @kindex l =
5827 The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory
5828 region. As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must
5829 be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant. The keyword
5830 @code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}.
5831
5832 In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions
5833 available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes,
5834 and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes. The
5835 linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which
5836 is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only
5837 or executable. The linker will place other sections which are not
5838 explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory
5839 region.
5840
5841 @smallexample
5842 @group
5843 MEMORY
5844 @{
5845 rom (rx) : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
5846 ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
5847 @}
5848 @end group
5849 @end smallexample
5850
5851 Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
5852 specific output sections into that memory region by using the
5853 @samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute. For example, if you have
5854 a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the
5855 output section definition. @xref{Output Section Region}. If no address
5856 was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to
5857 the next available address within the memory region. If the combined
5858 output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the
5859 region, the linker will issue an error message.
5860
5861 It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
5862 expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and
5863 @code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions:
5864
5865 @smallexample
5866 @group
5867 _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
5868 @end group
5869 @end smallexample
5870
5871 @node PHDRS
5872 @section PHDRS Command
5873 @kindex PHDRS
5874 @cindex program headers
5875 @cindex ELF program headers
5876 @cindex program segments
5877 @cindex segments, ELF
5878 The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as
5879 @dfn{segments}. The program headers describe how the program should be
5880 loaded into memory. You can print them out by using the @code{objdump}
5881 program with the @samp{-p} option.
5882
5883 When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
5884 reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
5885 program. This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
5886 This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
5887 interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
5888
5889 The linker will create reasonable program headers by default. However,
5890 in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
5891 precisely. You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose. When
5892 the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will
5893 not create any program headers other than the ones specified.
5894
5895 The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when
5896 generating an ELF output file. In other cases, the linker will simply
5897 ignore @code{PHDRS}.
5898
5899 This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command. The words @code{PHDRS},
5900 @code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords.
5901
5902 @smallexample
5903 @group
5904 PHDRS
5905 @{
5906 @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ]
5907 [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ;
5908 @}
5909 @end group
5910 @end smallexample
5911
5912 The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command
5913 of the linker script. It is not put into the output file. Program
5914 header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5915 with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each program header
5916 must have a distinct name. The headers are processed in order and it
5917 is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
5918
5919 Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
5920 system loader will load from the file. In the linker script, you
5921 specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
5922 sections in the segments. You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section
5923 attribute to place a section in a particular segment. @xref{Output
5924 Section Phdr}.
5925
5926 It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment. This
5927 merely implies that one segment of memory contains another. You may
5928 repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should
5929 contain the section.
5930
5931 If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}},
5932 then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do
5933 not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments. This is for
5934 convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be
5935 placed in a single segment. You can use @code{:NONE} to override the
5936 default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any
5937 segment at all.
5938
5939 @kindex FILEHDR
5940 @kindex PHDRS
5941 You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after
5942 the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment.
5943 The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF
5944 file header. The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should
5945 include the ELF program headers themselves. If applied to a loadable
5946 segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of
5947 these keywords.
5948
5949 The @var{type} may be one of the following. The numbers indicate the
5950 value of the keyword.
5951
5952 @table @asis
5953 @item @code{PT_NULL} (0)
5954 Indicates an unused program header.
5955
5956 @item @code{PT_LOAD} (1)
5957 Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from
5958 the file.
5959
5960 @item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2)
5961 Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
5962
5963 @item @code{PT_INTERP} (3)
5964 Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be
5965 found.
5966
5967 @item @code{PT_NOTE} (4)
5968 Indicates a segment holding note information.
5969
5970 @item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5)
5971 A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF
5972 ABI.
5973
5974 @item @code{PT_PHDR} (6)
5975 Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
5976
5977 @item @code{PT_TLS} (7)
5978 Indicates a segment containing thread local storage.
5979
5980 @item @var{expression}
5981 An expression giving the numeric type of the program header. This may
5982 be used for types not defined above.
5983 @end table
5984
5985 You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address
5986 in memory by using an @code{AT} expression. This is identical to the
5987 @code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output
5988 Section LMA}). The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the
5989 output section attribute.
5990
5991 The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
5992 which comprise the segment. You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to
5993 explicitly specify the segment flags. The value of @var{flags} must be
5994 an integer. It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program
5995 header.
5996
5997 Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}. This shows a typical set of program
5998 headers used on a native ELF system.
5999
6000 @example
6001 @group
6002 PHDRS
6003 @{
6004 headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
6005 interp PT_INTERP ;
6006 text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
6007 data PT_LOAD ;
6008 dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
6009 @}
6010
6011 SECTIONS
6012 @{
6013 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
6014 .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp
6015 .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text
6016 .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */
6017 @dots{}
6018 . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
6019 .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data
6020 .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic
6021 @dots{}
6022 @}
6023 @end group
6024 @end example
6025
6026 @node VERSION
6027 @section VERSION Command
6028 @kindex VERSION @{script text@}
6029 @cindex symbol versions
6030 @cindex version script
6031 @cindex versions of symbols
6032 The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF. Symbol versions are
6033 only useful when using shared libraries. The dynamic linker can use
6034 symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
6035 a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
6036 shared library.
6037
6038 You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or
6039 you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script. You can
6040 also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option.
6041
6042 The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply
6043 @smallexample
6044 VERSION @{ version-script-commands @}
6045 @end smallexample
6046
6047 The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by
6048 Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5. The version script defines a tree of
6049 version nodes. You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
6050 version script. You can specify which symbols are bound to which
6051 version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
6052 scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
6053 library.
6054
6055 The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few
6056 examples.
6057
6058 @smallexample
6059 VERS_1.1 @{
6060 global:
6061 foo1;
6062 local:
6063 old*;
6064 original*;
6065 new*;
6066 @};
6067
6068 VERS_1.2 @{
6069 foo2;
6070 @} VERS_1.1;
6071
6072 VERS_2.0 @{
6073 bar1; bar2;
6074 extern "C++" @{
6075 ns::*;
6076 "f(int, double)";
6077 @};
6078 @} VERS_1.2;
6079 @end smallexample
6080
6081 This example version script defines three version nodes. The first
6082 version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies.
6083 The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}. It reduces
6084 a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside
6085 of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
6086 symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new}
6087 is matched. The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used
6088 in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing'').
6089 However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the
6090 name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
6091
6092 Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}. This node
6093 depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}. The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2}
6094 to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}.
6095
6096 Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}. This node
6097 depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}. The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1}
6098 and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}.
6099
6100 When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
6101 specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
6102 unspecified base version of the library. You can bind all otherwise
6103 unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;}
6104 somewhere in the version script. Note that it's slightly crazy to use
6105 wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node. Global
6106 wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
6107 set exported for an old version. That's wrong since older versions
6108 ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
6109
6110 The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what
6111 they might suggest to the person reading them. The @samp{2.0} version
6112 could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}.
6113 However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
6114
6115 Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node
6116 in the version script. Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
6117 symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which
6118 won't.
6119
6120 @smallexample
6121 @{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @};
6122 @end smallexample
6123
6124 When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned
6125 symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it
6126 requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each
6127 shared library it is linked against. Thus at runtime, the dynamic
6128 loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
6129 linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
6130 application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols. In this
6131 way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
6132 all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
6133 search for each symbol reference.
6134
6135 The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
6136 doing minor version checking that SunOS does. The fundamental problem
6137 that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
6138 functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
6139 the application starts up. If a shared library is out of date, a
6140 required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
6141 that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail. With symbol
6142 versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
6143 the libraries being used with the application are too old.
6144
6145 There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach. The
6146 first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
6147 source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
6148 script. This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
6149 maintainer. You can do this by putting something like:
6150 @smallexample
6151 __asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6152 @end smallexample
6153 @noindent
6154 in the C source file. This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to
6155 be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}.
6156 The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol
6157 @samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive
6158 takes precedence over a version script.
6159
6160 The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
6161 function to appear in a given shared library. In this way you can make
6162 an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
6163 version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
6164 linked against the old interface to continue to function.
6165
6166 To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the
6167 source file. Here is an example:
6168
6169 @smallexample
6170 __asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@");
6171 __asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6172 __asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2");
6173 __asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0");
6174 @end smallexample
6175
6176 In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the
6177 unspecified base version of the symbol. The source file that contains this
6178 example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo},
6179 @samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}.
6180
6181 When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be
6182 some way to specify a default version to which external references to
6183 this symbol will be bound. You can do this with the
6184 @samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive. You can only
6185 declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise
6186 you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
6187
6188 If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
6189 within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
6190 (i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to
6191 specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
6192
6193 You can also specify the language in the version script:
6194
6195 @smallexample
6196 VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @}
6197 @end smallexample
6198
6199 The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}.
6200 The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and
6201 demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the
6202 patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}. The default
6203 @samp{lang} is @samp{C}.
6204
6205 Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters. As
6206 described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
6207 or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly. In
6208 the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
6209 whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
6210 cause a mismatch. As the exact string generated by the demangler
6211 might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you
6212 should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you
6213 expect when you upgrade.
6214
6215 @node Expressions
6216 @section Expressions in Linker Scripts
6217 @cindex expressions
6218 @cindex arithmetic
6219 The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
6220 that of C expressions. All expressions are evaluated as integers. All
6221 expressions are evaluated in the same size, which is 32 bits if both the
6222 host and target are 32 bits, and is otherwise 64 bits.
6223
6224 You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
6225
6226 The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in
6227 expressions.
6228
6229 @menu
6230 * Constants:: Constants
6231 * Symbolic Constants:: Symbolic constants
6232 * Symbols:: Symbol Names
6233 * Orphan Sections:: Orphan Sections
6234 * Location Counter:: The Location Counter
6235 * Operators:: Operators
6236 * Evaluation:: Evaluation
6237 * Expression Section:: The Section of an Expression
6238 * Builtin Functions:: Builtin Functions
6239 @end menu
6240
6241 @node Constants
6242 @subsection Constants
6243 @cindex integer notation
6244 @cindex constants in linker scripts
6245 All constants are integers.
6246
6247 As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be
6248 octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be
6249 hexadecimal. Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or
6250 @samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or
6251 @samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal. Any integer
6252 value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal.
6253
6254 @cindex scaled integers
6255 @cindex K and M integer suffixes
6256 @cindex M and K integer suffixes
6257 @cindex suffixes for integers
6258 @cindex integer suffixes
6259 In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a
6260 constant by
6261 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6262 @ifnottex
6263 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6264 @code{1024} or @code{1024*1024}
6265 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6266 @end ifnottex
6267 @tex
6268 ${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$
6269 @end tex
6270 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6271 respectively. For example, the following
6272 all refer to the same quantity:
6273
6274 @smallexample
6275 _fourk_1 = 4K;
6276 _fourk_2 = 4096;
6277 _fourk_3 = 0x1000;
6278 _fourk_4 = 10000o;
6279 @end smallexample
6280
6281 Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in
6282 conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above.
6283
6284 @node Symbolic Constants
6285 @subsection Symbolic Constants
6286 @cindex symbolic constants
6287 @kindex CONSTANT
6288 It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of
6289 the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of:
6290
6291 @table @code
6292 @item MAXPAGESIZE
6293 @kindex MAXPAGESIZE
6294 The target's maximum page size.
6295
6296 @item COMMONPAGESIZE
6297 @kindex COMMONPAGESIZE
6298 The target's default page size.
6299 @end table
6300
6301 So for example:
6302
6303 @smallexample
6304 .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @}
6305 @end smallexample
6306
6307 will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
6308 supported by the target.
6309
6310 @node Symbols
6311 @subsection Symbol Names
6312 @cindex symbol names
6313 @cindex names
6314 @cindex quoted symbol names
6315 @kindex "
6316 Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
6317 and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
6318 Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords. You can
6319 specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
6320 keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
6321 @smallexample
6322 "SECTION" = 9;
6323 "with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
6324 @end smallexample
6325
6326 Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest
6327 to delimit symbols with spaces. For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol,
6328 whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction.
6329
6330 @node Orphan Sections
6331 @subsection Orphan Sections
6332 @cindex orphan
6333 Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which
6334 are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker
6335 script. The linker will still copy these sections into the
6336 output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section
6337 in which to place the orphaned input section.
6338
6339 If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of
6340 an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be
6341 placed at the end of that output section.
6342
6343 If there is no output section with a matching name then new output
6344 sections will be created. Each new output section will have the same
6345 name as the orphan section placed within it. If there are multiple
6346 orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into
6347 one new output section.
6348
6349 If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections,
6350 then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections
6351 in relation to existing output sections. On most modern targets, the
6352 linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same
6353 attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc. If no
6354 sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this
6355 support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file.
6356
6357 The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique}
6358 (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which
6359 output sections an orphan is placed in.
6360
6361 @node Location Counter
6362 @subsection The Location Counter
6363 @kindex .
6364 @cindex dot
6365 @cindex location counter
6366 @cindex current output location
6367 The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the
6368 current output location counter. Since the @code{.} always refers to a
6369 location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression
6370 within a @code{SECTIONS} command. The @code{.} symbol may appear
6371 anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
6372
6373 @cindex holes
6374 Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be
6375 moved. This may be used to create holes in the output section. The
6376 location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
6377 and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so
6378 doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
6379
6380 @smallexample
6381 SECTIONS
6382 @{
6383 output :
6384 @{
6385 file1(.text)
6386 . = . + 1000;
6387 file2(.text)
6388 . += 1000;
6389 file3(.text)
6390 @} = 0x12345678;
6391 @}
6392 @end smallexample
6393 @noindent
6394 In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is
6395 located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}. It is
6396 followed by a 1000 byte gap. Then the @samp{.text} section from
6397 @file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the
6398 @samp{.text} section from @file{file3}. The notation @samp{= 0x12345678}
6399 specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}).
6400
6401 @cindex dot inside sections
6402 Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
6403 current containing object. Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS}
6404 statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an
6405 absolute address. If @code{.} is used inside a section description
6406 however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section,
6407 not an absolute address. Thus in a script like this:
6408
6409 @smallexample
6410 SECTIONS
6411 @{
6412 . = 0x100
6413 .text: @{
6414 *(.text)
6415 . = 0x200
6416 @}
6417 . = 0x500
6418 .data: @{
6419 *(.data)
6420 . += 0x600
6421 @}
6422 @}
6423 @end smallexample
6424
6425 The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100
6426 and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in
6427 the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area. (If there is too
6428 much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to
6429 move @code{.} backwards). The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500
6430 and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of
6431 the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of
6432 the @samp{.data} output section itself.
6433
6434 @cindex dot outside sections
6435 Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
6436 output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
6437 needs to place orphan sections. For example, given the following:
6438
6439 @smallexample
6440 SECTIONS
6441 @{
6442 start_of_text = . ;
6443 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6444 end_of_text = . ;
6445
6446 start_of_data = . ;
6447 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6448 end_of_data = . ;
6449 @}
6450 @end smallexample
6451
6452 If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata},
6453 not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section
6454 between @code{.text} and @code{.data}. You might think the linker
6455 should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but
6456 blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker. As well,
6457 the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their
6458 sections. Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other
6459 statements belong to the previous output section, except for the
6460 special case of an assignment to @code{.}. I.e., the linker will
6461 place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written
6462 as follows:
6463
6464 @smallexample
6465 SECTIONS
6466 @{
6467 start_of_text = . ;
6468 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6469 end_of_text = . ;
6470
6471 start_of_data = . ;
6472 .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @}
6473 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6474 end_of_data = . ;
6475 @}
6476 @end smallexample
6477
6478 This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
6479 @code{start_of_data}. One way to influence the orphan section
6480 placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker
6481 assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of
6482 a following output section and thus should be grouped with that
6483 section. So you could write:
6484
6485 @smallexample
6486 SECTIONS
6487 @{
6488 start_of_text = . ;
6489 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6490 end_of_text = . ;
6491
6492 . = . ;
6493 start_of_data = . ;
6494 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6495 end_of_data = . ;
6496 @}
6497 @end smallexample
6498
6499 Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between
6500 @code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}.
6501
6502 @need 2000
6503 @node Operators
6504 @subsection Operators
6505 @cindex operators for arithmetic
6506 @cindex arithmetic operators
6507 @cindex precedence in expressions
6508 The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
6509 the standard bindings and precedence levels:
6510 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6511 @ifnottex
6512 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6513 @smallexample
6514 precedence associativity Operators Notes
6515 (highest)
6516 1 left ! - ~ (1)
6517 2 left * / %
6518 3 left + -
6519 4 left >> <<
6520 5 left == != > < <= >=
6521 6 left &
6522 7 left |
6523 8 left &&
6524 9 left ||
6525 10 right ? :
6526 11 right &= += -= *= /= (2)
6527 (lowest)
6528 @end smallexample
6529 Notes:
6530 (1) Prefix operators
6531 (2) @xref{Assignments}.
6532 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6533 @end ifnottex
6534 @tex
6535 \vskip \baselineskip
6536 %"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample
6537 \hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip
6538 \hrule
6539 \halign
6540 {\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr
6541 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6542 &Precedence&& Associativity &&{\rm Operators}&\cr
6543 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6544 \noalign{\hrule}
6545 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6546 &highest&&&&&\cr
6547 % '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font
6548 &1&&left&&\qquad- \char'176\ !\qquad\dag&\cr
6549 &2&&left&&* / \%&\cr
6550 &3&&left&&+ -&\cr
6551 &4&&left&&>> <<&\cr
6552 &5&&left&&== != > < <= >=&\cr
6553 &6&&left&&\&&\cr
6554 &7&&left&&|&\cr
6555 &8&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr
6556 &9&&left&&||&\cr
6557 &10&&right&&? :&\cr
6558 &11&&right&&\qquad\&= += -= *= /=\qquad\ddag&\cr
6559 &lowest&&&&&\cr
6560 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr}
6561 \hrule}
6562 @end tex
6563 @iftex
6564 {
6565 @obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt
6566 @dag@quad Prefix operators.
6567 @ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}.
6568 }
6569 @end iftex
6570 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6571
6572 @node Evaluation
6573 @subsection Evaluation
6574 @cindex lazy evaluation
6575 @cindex expression evaluation order
6576 The linker evaluates expressions lazily. It only computes the value of
6577 an expression when absolutely necessary.
6578
6579 The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
6580 address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
6581 regions, in order to do any linking at all. These values are computed
6582 as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
6583
6584 However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
6585 until after storage allocation. Such values are evaluated later, when
6586 other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
6587 for use in the symbol assignment expression.
6588
6589 The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
6590 assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
6591 allocation.
6592
6593 Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
6594 @samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation.
6595
6596 If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
6597 available, then an error results. For example, a script like the
6598 following
6599 @smallexample
6600 @group
6601 SECTIONS
6602 @{
6603 .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
6604 @{ *(.text) @}
6605 @}
6606 @end group
6607 @end smallexample
6608 @noindent
6609 will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial
6610 address}.
6611
6612 @node Expression Section
6613 @subsection The Section of an Expression
6614 @cindex expression sections
6615 @cindex absolute expressions
6616 @cindex relative expressions
6617 @cindex absolute and relocatable symbols
6618 @cindex relocatable and absolute symbols
6619 @cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute
6620 Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute. A section
6621 relative symbol is relocatable. If you request relocatable output
6622 using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the
6623 value of a section relative symbol. On the other hand, an absolute
6624 symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link
6625 operations.
6626
6627 Some terms in linker expressions are addresses. This is true of
6628 section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
6629 address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and
6630 @code{SEGMENT_START}. Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin
6631 functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}.
6632 One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")}
6633 (@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated
6634 differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older
6635 versions of @code{ld}. Expressions appearing outside an output
6636 section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses.
6637 Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat
6638 absolute symbols as numbers. If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is
6639 given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers
6640 everywhere.
6641
6642 In the following simple example,
6643
6644 @smallexample
6645 @group
6646 SECTIONS
6647 @{
6648 . = 0x100;
6649 __executable_start = 0x100;
6650 .data :
6651 @{
6652 . = 0x10;
6653 __data_start = 0x10;
6654 *(.data)
6655 @}
6656 @dots{}
6657 @}
6658 @end group
6659 @end smallexample
6660
6661 both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute
6662 address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and
6663 @code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data}
6664 section in the second two assignments.
6665
6666 For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
6667 addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
6668
6669 @itemize @bullet
6670 @item
6671 Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
6672 operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
6673 absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
6674 @item
6675 Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two
6676 relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address
6677 and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es).
6678 @item
6679 Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not
6680 in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute
6681 address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address
6682 before applying the operator.
6683 @end itemize
6684
6685 The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
6686
6687 @itemize @bullet
6688 @item
6689 An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
6690 @item
6691 The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number.
6692 @item
6693 The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
6694 relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
6695 (after above conversions) is also a number when
6696 @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition
6697 but an absolute address otherwise.
6698 @item
6699 The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
6700 relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
6701 section as the relative operand(s).
6702 @item
6703 The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
6704 conversions) is an absolute address.
6705 @end itemize
6706
6707 You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression
6708 to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative. For example, to
6709 create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
6710 section @samp{.data}:
6711 @smallexample
6712 SECTIONS
6713 @{
6714 .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @}
6715 @}
6716 @end smallexample
6717 @noindent
6718 If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the
6719 @samp{.data} section.
6720
6721 Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this
6722 particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
6723
6724 @node Builtin Functions
6725 @subsection Builtin Functions
6726 @cindex functions in expressions
6727 The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
6728 use in linker script expressions.
6729
6730 @table @code
6731 @item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6732 @kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6733 @cindex expression, absolute
6734 Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value
6735 of the expression @var{exp}. Primarily useful to assign an absolute
6736 value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are
6737 normally section relative. @xref{Expression Section}.
6738
6739 @item ADDR(@var{section})
6740 @kindex ADDR(@var{section})
6741 @cindex section address in expression
6742 Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}. Your
6743 script must previously have defined the location of that section. In
6744 the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and
6745 @code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that
6746 @code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while
6747 the other two will be absolute:
6748 @smallexample
6749 @group
6750 SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6751 .output1 :
6752 @{
6753 start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
6754 @dots{}
6755 @}
6756 .output :
6757 @{
6758 symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
6759 symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
6760 @}
6761 @dots{} @}
6762 @end group
6763 @end smallexample
6764
6765 @item ALIGN(@var{align})
6766 @itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6767 @kindex ALIGN(@var{align})
6768 @kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6769 @cindex round up location counter
6770 @cindex align location counter
6771 @cindex round up expression
6772 @cindex align expression
6773 Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned
6774 to the next @var{align} boundary. The single operand @code{ALIGN}
6775 doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does
6776 arithmetic on it. The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary
6777 expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is
6778 equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}).
6779
6780 Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the
6781 next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
6782 variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the
6783 input sections:
6784 @smallexample
6785 @group
6786 SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6787 .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{
6788 *(.data)
6789 variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
6790 @}
6791 @dots{} @}
6792 @end group
6793 @end smallexample
6794 @noindent
6795 The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of
6796 a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of
6797 a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}). The second use
6798 of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol.
6799
6800 The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}.
6801
6802 @item ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6803 @kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6804 @cindex section alignment
6805 Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6806 been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6807 evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6808 the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the first
6809 value in that section.
6810 @smallexample
6811 @group
6812 SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6813 .output @{
6814 LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
6815 @dots{}
6816 @}
6817 @dots{} @}
6818 @end group
6819 @end smallexample
6820
6821 @item BLOCK(@var{exp})
6822 @kindex BLOCK(@var{exp})
6823 This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker
6824 scripts. It is most often seen when setting the address of an output
6825 section.
6826
6827 @item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6828 @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6829 This is equivalent to either
6830 @smallexample
6831 (ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1)))
6832 @end smallexample
6833 or
6834 @smallexample
6835 (ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize})
6836 + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize})))
6837 @end smallexample
6838 @noindent
6839 depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages
6840 for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and
6841 @code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not.
6842 If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime
6843 memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted
6844 bytes in the on-disk file.
6845
6846 This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in
6847 any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script.
6848 @var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should
6849 be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still
6850 running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}. Note however
6851 that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system
6852 page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}.
6853
6854 @noindent
6855 Example:
6856 @smallexample
6857 . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
6858 @end smallexample
6859
6860 @item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6861 @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6862 This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}
6863 evaluation purposes.
6864
6865 @smallexample
6866 . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
6867 @end smallexample
6868
6869 @item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6870 @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6871 This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when
6872 @samp{-z relro} option is used.
6873 When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END}
6874 does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that
6875 @var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize}
6876 argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}. If present in the linker
6877 script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and
6878 @code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}. Evaluates to the second argument plus any
6879 padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to
6880 section alignment.
6881
6882 @smallexample
6883 . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
6884 @end smallexample
6885
6886 @item DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6887 @kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6888 @cindex symbol defaults
6889 Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is
6890 defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
6891 return 0. You can use this function to provide
6892 default values for symbols. For example, the following script fragment
6893 shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in
6894 the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already
6895 existed, its value is preserved:
6896
6897 @smallexample
6898 @group
6899 SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6900 .text : @{
6901 begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
6902 @dots{}
6903 @}
6904 @dots{}
6905 @}
6906 @end group
6907 @end smallexample
6908
6909 @item LENGTH(@var{memory})
6910 @kindex LENGTH(@var{memory})
6911 Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6912
6913 @item LOADADDR(@var{section})
6914 @kindex LOADADDR(@var{section})
6915 @cindex section load address in expression
6916 Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}. (@pxref{Output
6917 Section LMA}).
6918
6919 @item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6920 @kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6921 Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity.
6922 @code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0.
6923
6924 @kindex MAX
6925 @item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6926 Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6927
6928 @kindex MIN
6929 @item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6930 Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6931
6932 @item NEXT(@var{exp})
6933 @kindex NEXT(@var{exp})
6934 @cindex unallocated address, next
6935 Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}.
6936 This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you
6937 use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the
6938 output file, the two functions are equivalent.
6939
6940 @item ORIGIN(@var{memory})
6941 @kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory})
6942 Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6943
6944 @item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
6945 @kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
6946 Return the base address of the named @var{segment}. If an explicit
6947 value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
6948 @samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
6949 will be @var{default}. At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option
6950 can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and
6951 ``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment
6952 name.
6953
6954 @item SIZEOF(@var{section})
6955 @kindex SIZEOF(@var{section})
6956 @cindex section size
6957 Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6958 been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6959 evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6960 @code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical values:
6961 @smallexample
6962 @group
6963 SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6964 .output @{
6965 .start = . ;
6966 @dots{}
6967 .end = . ;
6968 @}
6969 symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
6970 symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
6971 @dots{} @}
6972 @end group
6973 @end smallexample
6974
6975 @item SIZEOF_HEADERS
6976 @itemx sizeof_headers
6977 @kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS
6978 @cindex header size
6979 Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers. This is
6980 information which appears at the start of the output file. You can use
6981 this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you
6982 choose, to facilitate paging.
6983
6984 @cindex not enough room for program headers
6985 @cindex program headers, not enough room
6986 When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
6987 @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the
6988 number of program headers before it has determined all the section
6989 addresses and sizes. If the linker later discovers that it needs
6990 additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough
6991 room for program headers}. To avoid this error, you must avoid using
6992 the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker
6993 script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or
6994 you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS}
6995 command (@pxref{PHDRS}).
6996 @end table
6997
6998 @node Implicit Linker Scripts
6999 @section Implicit Linker Scripts
7000 @cindex implicit linker scripts
7001 If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
7002 an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
7003 linker script. If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
7004 linker will report an error.
7005
7006 An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
7007
7008 Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
7009 assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION}
7010 commands.
7011
7012 Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read
7013 at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was
7014 read. This can affect archive searching.
7015
7016 @node Plugins
7017 @chapter Linker Plugins
7018
7019 @cindex plugins
7020 @cindex linker plugins
7021 The linker can use dynamically loaded plugins to modify its behavior.
7022 For example, the link-time optimization feature that some compilers
7023 support is implemented with a linker plugin.
7024
7025 Currently there is only one plugin shipped by default, but more may
7026 be added here later.
7027
7028 @menu
7029 * libdep Plugin:: Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7030 @end menu
7031
7032 @node libdep Plugin
7033 @section Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7034 @cindex static library dependencies
7035 Originally, static libraries were contained in an archive file consisting
7036 just of a collection of relocatable object files. Later they evolved to
7037 optionally include a symbol table, to assist in finding the needed objects
7038 within a library. There their evolution ended, and dynamic libraries
7039 rose to ascendance.
7040
7041 One useful feature of dynamic libraries was that, more than just collecting
7042 multiple objects into a single file, they also included a list of their
7043 dependencies, such that one could specify just the name of a single dynamic
7044 library at link time, and all of its dependencies would be implicitly
7045 referenced as well. But static libraries lacked this feature, so if a
7046 link invocation was switched from using dynamic libraries to static
7047 libraries, the link command would usually fail unless it was rewritten to
7048 explicitly list the dependencies of the static library.
7049
7050 The GNU @command{ar} utility now supports a @option{--record-libdeps} option
7051 to embed dependency lists into static libraries as well, and the @file{libdep}
7052 plugin may be used to read this dependency information at link time. The
7053 dependency information is stored as a single string, carrying @option{-l}
7054 and @option{-L} arguments as they would normally appear in a linker
7055 command line. As such, the information can be written with any text
7056 utility and stored into any archive, even if GNU @command{ar} is not
7057 being used to create the archive. The information is stored in an
7058 archive member named @samp{__.LIBDEP}.
7059
7060 For example, given a library @file{libssl.a} that depends on another
7061 library @file{libcrypto.a} which may be found in @file{/usr/local/lib},
7062 the @samp{__.LIBDEP} member of @file{libssl.a} would contain
7063
7064 @smallexample
7065 -L/usr/local/lib -lcrypto
7066 @end smallexample
7067
7068 @ifset GENERIC
7069 @node Machine Dependent
7070 @chapter Machine Dependent Features
7071
7072 @cindex machine dependencies
7073 @command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following
7074 sections describe them. Machines where @command{ld} has no additional
7075 functionality are not listed.
7076
7077 @menu
7078 @ifset H8300
7079 * H8/300:: @command{ld} and the H8/300
7080 @end ifset
7081 @ifset M68HC11
7082 * M68HC11/68HC12:: @code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7083 @end ifset
7084 @ifset ARM
7085 * ARM:: @command{ld} and the ARM family
7086 @end ifset
7087 @ifset HPPA
7088 * HPPA ELF32:: @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF
7089 @end ifset
7090 @ifset M68K
7091 * M68K:: @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7092 @end ifset
7093 @ifset MIPS
7094 * MIPS:: @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7095 @end ifset
7096 @ifset MMIX
7097 * MMIX:: @command{ld} and MMIX
7098 @end ifset
7099 @ifset MSP430
7100 * MSP430:: @command{ld} and MSP430
7101 @end ifset
7102 @ifset NDS32
7103 * NDS32:: @command{ld} and NDS32
7104 @end ifset
7105 @ifset NIOSII
7106 * Nios II:: @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7107 @end ifset
7108 @ifset POWERPC
7109 * PowerPC ELF32:: @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7110 @end ifset
7111 @ifset POWERPC64
7112 * PowerPC64 ELF64:: @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7113 @end ifset
7114 @ifset S/390
7115 * S/390 ELF:: @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
7116 @end ifset
7117 @ifset SPU
7118 * SPU ELF:: @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
7119 @end ifset
7120 @ifset TICOFF
7121 * TI COFF:: @command{ld} and TI COFF
7122 @end ifset
7123 @ifset WIN32
7124 * WIN32:: @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
7125 @end ifset
7126 @ifset XTENSA
7127 * Xtensa:: @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors
7128 @end ifset
7129 @end menu
7130 @end ifset
7131
7132 @ifset H8300
7133 @ifclear GENERIC
7134 @raisesections
7135 @end ifclear
7136
7137 @node H8/300
7138 @section @command{ld} and the H8/300
7139
7140 @cindex H8/300 support
7141 For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when
7142 you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7143
7144 @table @emph
7145 @cindex relaxing on H8/300
7146 @item relaxing address modes
7147 @command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7148 targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7149 program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7150 respectively.
7151
7152 @cindex synthesizing on H8/300
7153 @item synthesizing instructions
7154 @c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S
7155 @command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the
7156 sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7157 page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form.
7158 (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into
7159 @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the
7160 top page of memory).
7161
7162 @command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register
7163 indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
7164 displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use
7165 the 16-bit displacement form. (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b
7166 @code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx}
7167 whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer
7168 range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld).
7169
7170 @item bit manipulation instructions
7171 @command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr,
7172 biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor}
7173 which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7174 page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form.
7175 (That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into
7176 @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
7177 the top page of memory).
7178
7179 @item system control instructions
7180 @command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the
7181 32 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
7182 changes them to use 16 bit address form.
7183 (That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into
7184 @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
7185 the top page of memory).
7186 @end table
7187
7188 @ifclear GENERIC
7189 @lowersections
7190 @end ifclear
7191 @end ifset
7192
7193 @ifclear GENERIC
7194 @ifset Renesas
7195 @c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned
7196 @c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please.
7197 @node Renesas
7198 @chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips
7199
7200 @command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H,
7201 H8/500, and SH chips. No special features, commands, or command-line
7202 options are required for these chips.
7203 @end ifset
7204 @end ifclear
7205
7206 @ifset ARM
7207 @ifclear GENERIC
7208 @raisesections
7209 @end ifclear
7210
7211 @ifset M68HC11
7212 @ifclear GENERIC
7213 @raisesections
7214 @end ifclear
7215
7216 @node M68HC11/68HC12
7217 @section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7218
7219 @cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support
7220
7221 @subsection Linker Relaxation
7222
7223 For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global
7224 optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7225
7226 @table @emph
7227 @cindex relaxing on M68HC11
7228 @item relaxing address modes
7229 @command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7230 targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7231 program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7232 respectively.
7233
7234 @command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
7235 transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
7236 page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
7237
7238 @item relaxing gcc instruction group
7239 When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group
7240 of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
7241 addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or
7242 @code{bset} instructions.
7243
7244 @end table
7245
7246 @subsection Trampoline Generation
7247
7248 @cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11
7249 @cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12
7250 For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to
7251 call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker
7252 will also change the relocation to some far function to use the
7253 trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the
7254 case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact
7255 point to the function trampoline.
7256
7257 @ifclear GENERIC
7258 @lowersections
7259 @end ifclear
7260 @end ifset
7261
7262 @node ARM
7263 @section @command{ld} and the ARM family
7264
7265 @cindex ARM interworking support
7266 @kindex --support-old-code
7267 For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
7268 between ARM and Thumb code. These stubs only work with code that has
7269 been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command
7270 line option. If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
7271 libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
7272 option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be
7273 given to the linker. This will make it generate larger stub functions
7274 which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code. Note, however,
7275 the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
7276 non-interworking aware Thumb code.
7277
7278 @cindex thumb entry point
7279 @cindex entry point, thumb
7280 @kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry}
7281 The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic
7282 @samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.
7283 But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be
7284 branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start
7285 executing in Thumb mode straight away.
7286
7287 @cindex PE import table prefixing
7288 @kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables
7289 The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that
7290 the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
7291 element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
7292 import tables. By default this option is turned off.
7293
7294 @cindex BE8
7295 @kindex --be8
7296 The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format
7297 executables. This option is only valid when linking big-endian
7298 objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB}
7299 option. The resulting image will contain big-endian data and
7300 little-endian code.
7301
7302 @cindex TARGET1
7303 @kindex --target1-rel
7304 @kindex --target1-abs
7305 The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the
7306 @samp{.init_array} section. It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32}
7307 or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target. The @samp{--target1-rel}
7308 and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default.
7309
7310 @cindex TARGET2
7311 @kindex --target2=@var{type}
7312 The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the
7313 @samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation. Valid values for @samp{type}, their
7314 meanings, and target defaults are as follows:
7315 @table @samp
7316 @item rel
7317 @samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
7318 @item abs
7319 @samp{R_ARM_ABS32} (arm*-*-symbianelf)
7320 @item got-rel
7321 @samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
7322 @end table
7323
7324 @cindex FIX_V4BX
7325 @kindex --fix-v4bx
7326 The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF
7327 specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
7328 interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but
7329 also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects.
7330
7331 In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the
7332 linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as
7333 @code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction.
7334
7335 In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7336 relocations are ignored.
7337
7338 @cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
7339 @kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking
7340 Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7341 relocations with a branch to the following veneer:
7342
7343 @smallexample
7344 TST rM, #1
7345 MOVEQ PC, rM
7346 BX Rn
7347 @end smallexample
7348
7349 This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores
7350 and are still interworking safe. Note that the above veneer clobbers the
7351 condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases.
7352
7353 @cindex USE_BLX
7354 @kindex --use-blx
7355 The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb
7356 BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various
7357 situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb
7358 code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before
7359 each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
7360
7361 This option is enabled implicitly for SymbianOS, so there is no need to
7362 specify it if you are using that target.
7363
7364 @cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX
7365 @kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix
7366 The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a
7367 bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
7368 instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code)
7369 to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before
7370 the support code can read the intended values.
7371
7372 The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
7373 intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register
7374 and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two
7375 intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects
7376 full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if
7377 you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details.
7378
7379 If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can
7380 enable this workaround by specifying the linker option
7381 @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar
7382 mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using
7383 vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is
7384 @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}.
7385
7386 If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7387 potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7388 such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
7389 first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
7390 instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
7391 the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
7392 are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
7393
7394 @cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround
7395 @kindex --fix-arm1176
7396 @kindex --no-fix-arm1176
7397 The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum
7398 in certain ARM1176 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you
7399 are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier. It can be disabled
7400 unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}.
7401
7402 Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
7403 Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at:
7404 http://infocenter.arm.com/.
7405
7406 @cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround
7407 @kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360
7408
7409 The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time
7410 workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of
7411 the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx). When accessing
7412 off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more,
7413 the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort. These are only
7414 core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access:
7415 integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM,
7416 VPOP. Stores are not affected.
7417
7418 The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the
7419 necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words.
7420
7421 The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use
7422 @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}. If you know you are using buggy
7423 STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the
7424 linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent
7425 @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}.
7426
7427 If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7428 potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7429 such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists in a
7430 replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a
7431 branch back to the subsequent instruction. The original instruction is
7432 then replaced with a branch to the veneer.
7433
7434 The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for
7435 the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC.
7436
7437 The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when
7438 they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed
7439 there. In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7440 occurs.
7441
7442 The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a
7443 PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too
7444 large. In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code
7445 cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7446 occurs.
7447
7448 @cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING
7449 @kindex --no-enum-size-warning
7450 The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7451 warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7452 enumeration size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7453 linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another
7454 using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will
7455 not be diagnosed.
7456
7457 @cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING
7458 @kindex --no-wchar-size-warning
7459 The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7460 warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7461 @code{wchar_t} size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7462 linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another
7463 using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed.
7464
7465 @cindex PIC_VENEER
7466 @kindex --pic-veneer
7467 The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
7468 ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary
7469 is not PIC. This avoids problems on uClinux targets where
7470 @samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries.
7471
7472 @cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE
7473 @kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7474 The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
7475 code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
7476 perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away. The
7477 placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
7478 controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}.
7479 The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
7480 duplicate stubs, increasing the code size. The linker will try to
7481 group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
7482 code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
7483 where they should be placed.
7484
7485 The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the
7486 @option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are
7487 placed. If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first
7488 branch that needs them. If it is positive then the stubs can be
7489 placed either before or after the branches that need them. If the
7490 value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose
7491 exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics.
7492 A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the
7493 linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes
7494 from the input sections.
7495
7496 The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is
7497 @samp{N = +1}.
7498
7499 Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
7500 only, because it relies on object files properties not present
7501 otherwise.
7502
7503 @cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround
7504 @kindex --fix-cortex-a8
7505 @kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8
7506 The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile. It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}.
7507
7508 The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code. Please contact ARM for further details.
7509
7510 @cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround
7511 @kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769
7512 @kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769
7513 The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors. The workaround is disabled by default. It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}.
7514
7515 Please contact ARM for further details.
7516
7517 @kindex --merge-exidx-entries
7518 @kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
7519 @cindex Merging exidx entries
7520 The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
7521
7522 @kindex --long-plt
7523 @cindex 32-bit PLT entries
7524 The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries
7525 which support up to 4Gb of code. The default is to use 12 byte PLT
7526 entries which only support 512Mb of code.
7527
7528 @kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs
7529 @cindex AArch64 rela addend
7530 The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply
7531 link-time values for dynamic relocations.
7532
7533 @cindex Placement of SG veneers
7534 All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}.
7535 Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option
7536 @samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these
7537 veneers in memory.
7538
7539 @kindex --cmse-implib
7540 @cindex Secure gateway import library
7541 The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries
7542 specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are
7543 secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure
7544 executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions.
7545
7546 @kindex --in-implib=@var{file}
7547 @cindex Input import library
7548 The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols
7549 must keep the same address in the executable being produced. A warning is
7550 given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced
7551 in the executable that should be listed in its import library. Otherwise, if
7552 @samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import
7553 library. A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import
7554 library have disappeared from the executable. This option is only effective
7555 for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is
7556 specified.
7557
7558 @ifclear GENERIC
7559 @lowersections
7560 @end ifclear
7561 @end ifset
7562
7563 @ifset HPPA
7564 @ifclear GENERIC
7565 @raisesections
7566 @end ifclear
7567
7568 @node HPPA ELF32
7569 @section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
7570 @cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs
7571 @kindex --multi-subspace
7572 When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate
7573 import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.
7574 The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export
7575 stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with
7576 multiple sub-spaces.
7577
7578 @cindex HPPA stub grouping
7579 @kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7580 Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in
7581 stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7582 @samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7583 sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7584 a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7585 the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7586 conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7587 prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7588 A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7589 branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7590 @samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7591 @command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7592 detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7593 positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7594
7595 Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7596 single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7597 create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7598 large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7599
7600 @ifclear GENERIC
7601 @lowersections
7602 @end ifclear
7603 @end ifset
7604
7605 @ifset M68K
7606 @ifclear GENERIC
7607 @raisesections
7608 @end ifclear
7609
7610 @node M68K
7611 @section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7612
7613 @cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation
7614 @kindex --got=@var{type}
7615 The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.
7616 The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and
7617 @samp{target}. When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses
7618 the default GOT generation scheme for the current target.
7619 @samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with
7620 entries only at non-negative offsets.
7621 @samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with
7622 entries at both negative and positive offsets. Not all environments
7623 support such GOTs.
7624 @samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the
7625 output file. All GOT references from a single input object
7626 file access the same GOT, but references from different input object
7627 files might access different GOTs. Not all environments support such GOTs.
7628
7629 @ifclear GENERIC
7630 @lowersections
7631 @end ifclear
7632 @end ifset
7633
7634 @ifset MIPS
7635 @ifclear GENERIC
7636 @raisesections
7637 @end ifclear
7638
7639 @node MIPS
7640 @section @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7641
7642 @cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection
7643 @kindex --insn32
7644 @kindex --no-insn32
7645 The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of
7646 microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that
7647 in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is
7648 used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings. By default
7649 or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used,
7650 including 16-bit ones where possible.
7651
7652 @cindex MIPS branch relocation check control
7653 @kindex --ignore-branch-isa
7654 @kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
7655 The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options
7656 control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions. If
7657 @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch
7658 relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation
7659 calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet
7660 relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX}
7661 instructions as the associated relocation is calculated. By default
7662 or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing
7663 the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error.
7664
7665 @ifclear GENERIC
7666 @lowersections
7667 @end ifclear
7668 @end ifset
7669
7670 @ifset MMIX
7671 @ifclear GENERIC
7672 @raisesections
7673 @end ifclear
7674
7675 @node MMIX
7676 @section @code{ld} and MMIX
7677 For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or
7678 @code{mmo} object files when linking. The simulator @code{mmix}
7679 understands the @code{mmo} format. The binutils @code{objcopy} utility
7680 can translate between the two formats.
7681
7682 There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section.
7683 Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
7684 registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols,
7685 equal to registers. In a final link, the start address of the
7686 @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated
7687 global register multiplied by 8. Register @code{$255} is not included in
7688 this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the
7689 symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files.
7690
7691 Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example
7692 @code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special.
7693 The default linker script uses these to set the default start address
7694 of a section.
7695
7696 Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section,
7697 are left out from an mmo file.
7698
7699 @ifclear GENERIC
7700 @lowersections
7701 @end ifclear
7702 @end ifset
7703
7704 @ifset MSP430
7705 @ifclear GENERIC
7706 @raisesections
7707 @end ifclear
7708
7709 @node MSP430
7710 @section @code{ld} and MSP430
7711 For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture. The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]}
7712 will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type. (To get a list of known MPUs
7713 just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker).
7714
7715 @cindex MSP430 extra sections
7716 The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific:
7717
7718 @table @code
7719 @item @samp{.vectors}
7720 Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
7721
7722 @item @samp{.bootloader}
7723 Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable). Any code
7724 in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7725
7726 @item @samp{.infomem}
7727 Defines an information memory section (if applicable). Any code in
7728 this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7729
7730 @item @samp{.infomemnobits}
7731 This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code
7732 in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
7733
7734 @item @samp{.noinit}
7735 Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section.
7736
7737 The last two sections are used by gcc.
7738 @end table
7739
7740 @table @option
7741 @cindex MSP430 Options
7742 @kindex --code-region
7743 @item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7744 This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The
7745 argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker
7746 using this option.
7747
7748 @kindex --data-region
7749 @item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7750 This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to
7751 [either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC
7752 for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option.
7753
7754 @kindex --disable-sec-transformation
7755 @item --disable-sec-transformation
7756 Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region}
7757 and @code{--data-region} options.
7758 This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC
7759 wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but
7760 not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects.
7761 @end table
7762
7763 @ifclear GENERIC
7764 @lowersections
7765 @end ifclear
7766 @end ifset
7767
7768 @ifset NDS32
7769 @ifclear GENERIC
7770 @raisesections
7771 @end ifclear
7772
7773 @node NDS32
7774 @section @code{ld} and NDS32
7775 @kindex relaxing on NDS32
7776 For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior. The linker
7777 relaxes objects according to these options.
7778
7779 @table @code
7780 @item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp}
7781 Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
7782
7783 @item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE}
7784 Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
7785
7786 @item @samp{--m[no-]ex9}
7787 Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
7788
7789 @item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE}
7790 Export the EX9 table after linking.
7791
7792 @item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE}
7793 Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
7794
7795 @item @samp{--mupdate-ex9}
7796 Update the existing EX9 table.
7797
7798 @item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM}
7799 Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
7800
7801 @item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware}
7802 Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
7803
7804 @item @samp{--m[no-]ifc}
7805 Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
7806
7807 @item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware}
7808 Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
7809 @end table
7810
7811 @ifclear GENERIC
7812 @lowersections
7813 @end ifclear
7814 @end ifset
7815
7816 @ifset NIOSII
7817 @ifclear GENERIC
7818 @raisesections
7819 @end ifclear
7820
7821 @node Nios II
7822 @section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7823 @cindex Nios II call relaxation
7824 @kindex --relax on Nios II
7825
7826 Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to
7827 transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
7828 which may result in @command{ld} giving
7829 @samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7830 The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of
7831 trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls
7832 outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range. These
7833 trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
7834 be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are
7835 larger than 256MB.
7836
7837 The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r}
7838 is also specified. You can disable trampoline generation by using the
7839 @option{--no-relax} linker option. You can also disable this optimization
7840 locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language
7841 source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at}
7842 register as a temporary.
7843
7844 Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler
7845 relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all}
7846 option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation.
7847
7848 @ifclear GENERIC
7849 @lowersections
7850 @end ifclear
7851 @end ifset
7852
7853 @ifset POWERPC
7854 @ifclear GENERIC
7855 @raisesections
7856 @end ifclear
7857
7858 @node PowerPC ELF32
7859 @section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7860 @cindex PowerPC long branches
7861 @kindex --relax on PowerPC
7862 Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
7863 displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving
7864 @samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7865 @samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access
7866 the entire 32-bit address space. These trampolines are inserted at
7867 section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input
7868 section exceeds 33M in size. You may combine @samp{-r} and
7869 @samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link. In that case
7870 both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
7871 considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
7872
7873 @cindex PowerPC ELF32 options
7874 @table @option
7875 @cindex PowerPC PLT
7876 @kindex --bss-plt
7877 @item --bss-plt
7878 Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that
7879 generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has
7880 the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
7881 writable and no writable section ever being executable. PowerPC
7882 @command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the
7883 PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
7884 compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}. @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old
7885 BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
7886
7887 @kindex --secure-plt
7888 @item --secure-plt
7889 @command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
7890 @samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically
7891 when linking non-PIC code. This option requests the new PLT and GOT
7892 layout. A warning will be given if some object file requires the old
7893 style BSS PLT.
7894
7895 @cindex PowerPC GOT
7896 @kindex --sdata-got
7897 @item --sdata-got
7898 The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
7899 sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement. The location of
7900 @code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized
7901 section while the old PLT is uninitialized. The reason for the
7902 @code{.got} change is more subtle: The new placement allows
7903 @code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with
7904 @samp{-z relro -z now}. However, this placement means that
7905 @code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the
7906 PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT
7907 pointer. @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement. PowerPC
7908 GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is
7909 really only useful for other compilers that may do so.
7910
7911 @cindex PowerPC stub symbols
7912 @kindex --emit-stub-syms
7913 @item --emit-stub-syms
7914 This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7915 symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7916
7917 @cindex PowerPC TLS optimization
7918 @kindex --no-tls-optimize
7919 @item --no-tls-optimize
7920 PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
7921 sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
7922 disable the optimization.
7923 @end table
7924
7925 @ifclear GENERIC
7926 @lowersections
7927 @end ifclear
7928 @end ifset
7929
7930 @ifset POWERPC64
7931 @ifclear GENERIC
7932 @raisesections
7933 @end ifclear
7934
7935 @node PowerPC64 ELF64
7936 @section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7937
7938 @cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options
7939 @table @option
7940 @cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping
7941 @kindex --stub-group-size
7942 @item --stub-group-size
7943 Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs and TOC adjusting stubs are placed
7944 by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7945 @samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7946 sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7947 a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7948 the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7949 conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7950 prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7951 A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7952 branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7953 @samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7954 @command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7955 detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7956 positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7957
7958 Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7959 single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7960 create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7961 large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7962
7963 @cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols
7964 @kindex --emit-stub-syms
7965 @item --emit-stub-syms
7966 This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7967 symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7968
7969 @cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols
7970 @kindex --dotsyms
7971 @kindex --no-dotsyms
7972 @item --dotsyms
7973 @itemx --no-dotsyms
7974 These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns
7975 in a version script. Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
7976 function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a
7977 code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}). To
7978 properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs
7979 to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}. The option
7980 @samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required
7981 dot-prefixed patterns. Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this
7982 feature.
7983
7984 @cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions
7985 @kindex --save-restore-funcs
7986 @kindex --no-save-restore-funcs
7987 @item --save-restore-funcs
7988 @itemx --no-save-restore-funcs
7989 These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically
7990 provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by
7991 @samp{-Os} code. The default is to provide any such referenced
7992 function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable
7993 link.
7994
7995 @cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization
7996 @kindex --no-tls-optimize
7997 @item --no-tls-optimize
7998 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
7999 sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
8000 disable the optimization.
8001
8002 @cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization
8003 @kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize
8004 @kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
8005 @kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave
8006 @kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave
8007 @item --tls-get-addr-optimize
8008 @itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
8009 These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special
8010 stub to call __tls_get_addr. PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support
8011 an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to
8012 @code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special
8013 stub without calling in to glibc. By default the linker enables
8014 generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of
8015 __tls_get_addr_opt.
8016 Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do
8017 much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking
8018 an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it
8019 will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc.
8020 @option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves
8021 and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc. Normally,
8022 this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc.
8023 Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt.
8024 @option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the
8025 register saves.
8026
8027 @cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization
8028 @kindex --no-opd-optimize
8029 @item --no-opd-optimize
8030 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries
8031 corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by
8032 the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}.
8033 Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization.
8034
8035 @cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing
8036 @kindex --non-overlapping-opd
8037 @item --non-overlapping-opd
8038 Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
8039 @code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
8040 the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next
8041 entry. This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
8042
8043 @cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization
8044 @kindex --no-toc-optimize
8045 @item --no-toc-optimize
8046 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section
8047 entries. Such entries are detected by examining relocations that
8048 reference the TOC in code sections. A reloc in a deleted code section
8049 marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section
8050 marks a TOC word as needed. Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
8051 relocs are also examined. TOC words marked as both needed and
8052 unneeded will of course be kept. TOC words without any referencing
8053 reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
8054 discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word. This works
8055 reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly
8056 code is used to insert TOC entries. Use this option to disable the
8057 optimization.
8058
8059 @cindex PowerPC64 inline PLT call optimization
8060 @kindex --no-inline-optimize
8061 @item --no-inline-optimize
8062 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally replaces inline PLT call sequences
8063 marked with @code{R_PPC64_PLTSEQ}, @code{R_PPC64_PLTCALL},
8064 @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_HA} and @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS} relocations by
8065 a number of @code{nop}s and a direct call when the function is defined
8066 locally and can't be overridden by some other definition. This option
8067 disables that optimization.
8068
8069 @cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC
8070 @kindex --no-multi-toc
8071 @item --no-multi-toc
8072 If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or
8073 @code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
8074 where TOC
8075 entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2. This limits the
8076 total TOC size to 64K. PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by
8077 grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its
8078 TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group
8079 calls. @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot
8080 help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds
8081 64K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}.
8082 Use this option to turn off this feature.
8083
8084 @cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting
8085 @kindex --no-toc-sort
8086 @item --no-toc-sort
8087 By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
8088 happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are
8089 placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated
8090 with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections
8091 referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
8092 @code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options. Doing this
8093 results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC. Use this option to turn
8094 off this feature.
8095
8096 @cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment
8097 @kindex --plt-align
8098 @kindex --no-plt-align
8099 @item --plt-align
8100 @itemx --no-plt-align
8101 Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
8102 aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two
8103 boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}. A negative value may be
8104 specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the
8105 specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries
8106 if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary). By default
8107 PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries.
8108
8109 @cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain
8110 @kindex --plt-static-chain
8111 @kindex --no-plt-static-chain
8112 @item --plt-static-chain
8113 @itemx --no-plt-static-chain
8114 Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
8115 chain pointer (r11). @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static
8116 chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
8117
8118 @cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety
8119 @kindex --plt-thread-safe
8120 @kindex --no-plt-thread-safe
8121 @item --plt-thread-safe
8122 @itemx --no-plt-thread-safe
8123 With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using
8124 lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have
8125 another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong
8126 order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using
8127 memory write barriers. To avoid this we need some sort of read
8128 barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1. By default, @code{ld}
8129 looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if
8130 seen, adds the necessary barriers. Use these options to change the
8131 default behaviour.
8132
8133 @cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization
8134 @kindex --plt-localentry
8135 @kindex --no-plt-localentry
8136 @item --plt-localentry
8137 @itemx --no-localentry
8138 ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point,
8139 ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2
8140 (the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return.
8141 Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2
8142 or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small
8143 functions. The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction
8144 in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol
8145 interposition failures. Also, minor changes in a shared library,
8146 including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0
8147 to become localentry:8. This will result in a dynamic loader
8148 complaint and failure to run. The option is experimental, use with
8149 care. @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default.
8150
8151 @cindex PowerPC64 Power10 stubs
8152 @kindex --power10-stubs
8153 @kindex --no-power10-stubs
8154 @item --power10-stubs
8155 @itemx --no-power10-stubs
8156 When PowerPC64 @command{ld} links input object files containing
8157 relocations used on power10 prefixed instructions it normally creates
8158 linkage stubs (PLT call and long branch) using power10 instructions
8159 for @code{@@notoc} PLT calls where @code{r2} is not known. The
8160 power10 notoc stubs are smaller and faster, so are preferred for
8161 power10. @option{--power10-stubs} and @option{--no-power10-stubs}
8162 allow you to override the linker's selection of stub instructions.
8163 @option{--power10-stubs=auto} allows the user to select the default
8164 auto mode.
8165 @end table
8166
8167 @ifclear GENERIC
8168 @lowersections
8169 @end ifclear
8170 @end ifset
8171
8172 @ifset S/390
8173 @ifclear GENERIC
8174 @raisesections
8175 @end ifclear
8176
8177 @node S/390 ELF
8178 @section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
8179
8180 @cindex S/390 ELF options
8181 @table @option
8182
8183 @cindex S/390
8184 @kindex --s390-pgste
8185 @item --s390-pgste
8186 This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE}
8187 segment. The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for
8188 binaries marked that way.
8189 @end table
8190
8191 @ifclear GENERIC
8192 @lowersections
8193 @end ifclear
8194 @end ifset
8195
8196 @ifset SPU
8197 @ifclear GENERIC
8198 @raisesections
8199 @end ifclear
8200
8201 @node SPU ELF
8202 @section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
8203
8204 @cindex SPU ELF options
8205 @table @option
8206
8207 @cindex SPU plugins
8208 @kindex --plugin
8209 @item --plugin
8210 This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
8211
8212 @cindex SPU overlays
8213 @kindex --no-overlays
8214 @item --no-overlays
8215 Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay
8216 regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
8217 @command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager. This option
8218 turns off all this special overlay handling.
8219
8220 @cindex SPU overlay stub symbols
8221 @kindex --emit-stub-syms
8222 @item --emit-stub-syms
8223 This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local
8224 symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8225
8226 @cindex SPU extra overlay stubs
8227 @kindex --extra-overlay-stubs
8228 @item --extra-overlay-stubs
8229 This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all
8230 function calls out of overlay regions. Normally stubs are not added
8231 on calls to non-overlay regions.
8232
8233 @cindex SPU local store size
8234 @kindex --local-store=lo:hi
8235 @item --local-store=lo:hi
8236 @command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in
8237 the address range 0 to 256k. This option may be used to change the
8238 range. Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}.
8239
8240 @cindex SPU
8241 @kindex --stack-analysis
8242 @item --stack-analysis
8243 SPU local store space is limited. Over-allocation of stack space
8244 unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
8245 under-allocation results in runtime failures. If given this option,
8246 @command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
8247 @command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to
8248 determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues
8249 for stack adjusting instructions. A call-graph is created by looking
8250 for relocations on branch instructions. The graph is then searched
8251 for the maximum stack usage path. Note that this analysis does not
8252 find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion
8253 and other cycles in the call graph. Stack usage may be
8254 under-estimated if your code makes such calls. Also, stack usage for
8255 dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected. If a link map
8256 is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage
8257 and calls will be given.
8258
8259 @cindex SPU
8260 @kindex --emit-stack-syms
8261 @item --emit-stack-syms
8262 This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result
8263 in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.
8264 These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global
8265 functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static
8266 functions. @code{<number>} is the section id in hex. The value of
8267 such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function.
8268 The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding
8269 @code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}.
8270 @end table
8271
8272 @ifclear GENERIC
8273 @lowersections
8274 @end ifclear
8275 @end ifset
8276
8277 @ifset TICOFF
8278 @ifclear GENERIC
8279 @raisesections
8280 @end ifclear
8281
8282 @node TI COFF
8283 @section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
8284 @cindex TI COFF versions
8285 @kindex --format=@var{version}
8286 The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various
8287 TI COFF versions. The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are
8288 also supported. The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order
8289 format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output
8290 header format depends on the default specified by the specific target.
8291
8292 @ifclear GENERIC
8293 @lowersections
8294 @end ifclear
8295 @end ifset
8296
8297 @ifset WIN32
8298 @ifclear GENERIC
8299 @raisesections
8300 @end ifclear
8301
8302 @node WIN32
8303 @section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
8304
8305 This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues.
8306 See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the
8307 command-line options mentioned here.
8308
8309 @table @emph
8310 @cindex import libraries
8311 @item import libraries
8312 The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
8313 libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's. They are
8314 regular static archives and are handled as any other static
8315 archive. The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific
8316 support for creating such libraries provided with the
8317 @samp{--out-implib} command-line option.
8318
8319 @item exporting DLL symbols
8320 @cindex exporting DLL symbols
8321 The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
8322
8323 @table @emph
8324 @item using auto-export functionality
8325 @cindex using auto-export functionality
8326 By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality,
8327 which is controlled by the following command-line options:
8328
8329 @itemize
8330 @item --export-all-symbols [This is the default]
8331 @item --exclude-symbols
8332 @item --exclude-libs
8333 @item --exclude-modules-for-implib
8334 @item --version-script
8335 @end itemize
8336
8337 When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local
8338 (global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few
8339 symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries. As it will
8340 often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
8341 private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line
8342 options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for
8343 exporting. The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the
8344 final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
8345
8346 If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the
8347 command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled}
8348 if either of the following are true:
8349
8350 @itemize
8351 @item A DEF file is used.
8352 @item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
8353 @end itemize
8354
8355 @item using a DEF file
8356 @cindex using a DEF file
8357 Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file. A DEF file is
8358 an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be
8359 exported when a dll is created. Usually it is named @samp{<dll
8360 name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's
8361 command line. The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}.
8362
8363 @example
8364 gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
8365 @end example
8366
8367 Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the
8368 @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8369
8370 Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}:
8371
8372 @example
8373 LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
8374
8375 EXPORTS
8376 foo
8377 bar
8378 _bar = bar
8379 another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
8380 var1 DATA
8381 doo = foo == foo2
8382 eoo DATA == var1
8383 @end example
8384
8385 This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven
8386 symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an
8387 alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved
8388 by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for
8389 @code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol
8390 @code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in
8391 export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name
8392 in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export
8393 symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}.
8394
8395 The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal}
8396 name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix,
8397 the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended.
8398
8399 When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a
8400 library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of
8401 @code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default
8402 executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended.
8403
8404 With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional
8405 specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a
8406 non-default base address for the image.
8407
8408 If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor @code{NAME <name>} is specified,
8409 or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the
8410 filename specified on the command line.
8411
8412 The complete specification of an export symbol is:
8413
8414 @example
8415 EXPORTS
8416 ( ( ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
8417 | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
8418 [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
8419 @end example
8420
8421 Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares
8422 @samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares
8423 @samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol
8424 @samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}.
8425 Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
8426 @samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used
8427 string in import/export table for the symbol.
8428
8429 The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
8430
8431 @code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table. It
8432 will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified
8433 by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the
8434 linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import
8435 library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified.
8436
8437 @code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function.
8438 The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as
8439 the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as
8440 @code{*_imp__foo}).
8441
8442 @code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as
8443 well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the
8444 read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the
8445 variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add
8446 the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the
8447 extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the
8448 application will behave unexpectedly.
8449
8450 @code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put
8451 it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The
8452 symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress}
8453 API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to
8454 the DLL without an import library.
8455
8456 See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of
8457 other DEF file statements
8458
8459 @cindex creating a DEF file
8460 While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file
8461 with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option.
8462
8463 @item Using decorations
8464 @cindex Using decorations
8465 Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code
8466 itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is
8467 declared as:
8468
8469 @example
8470 __declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
8471 __declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
8472 @end example
8473
8474 All such symbols will be exported from the DLL. If, however,
8475 any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in
8476 this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless
8477 the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8478
8479 Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not}
8480 decorate them with dllexport. Instead, they should use dllimport,
8481 instead:
8482
8483 @example
8484 __declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
8485 __declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
8486 @end example
8487
8488 This complicates the structure of library header files, because
8489 when included by the library itself the header must declare the
8490 variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client
8491 code the header must declare them as dllimport. There are a number
8492 of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can
8493 omit the __declspec() declaration completely. See
8494 @samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more
8495 information.
8496 @end table
8497
8498 @cindex automatic data imports
8499 @item automatic data imports
8500 The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only
8501 by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the
8502 compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this
8503 issue. This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x
8504 code to these platforms, especially for large
8505 c++ libraries and applications. The auto-import feature, which was
8506 initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
8507 decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x
8508 platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import}
8509 command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw.
8510 The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to
8511 suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects
8512 trigger the feature's use.
8513
8514 auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
8515 additional assistance. Sometimes, you will see this message
8516
8517 "variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
8518 documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
8519
8520 The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error
8521 occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty.
8522 One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described
8523 below.
8524
8525 @cindex runtime pseudo-relocation
8526 For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes),
8527 object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an
8528 offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular
8529 field or public member, for instance. Unfortunately, the runtime loader used
8530 in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime
8531 without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.
8532 The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these
8533 references.
8534
8535 The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to
8536 be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references
8537 themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the
8538 runtime environment. Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and
8539 compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not. However, the
8540 support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will
8541 run without error on an older system.
8542
8543 @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly
8544 enabled as needed.
8545
8546 @cindex direct linking to a dll
8547 @item direct linking to a dll
8548 The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking,
8549 including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
8550 libraries. This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the
8551 traditional import library method, especially when linking large
8552 libraries or applications. When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each
8553 function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even
8554 though a single bfd could contain many exports. The overhead involved in
8555 storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
8556 tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly
8557 large or complex libraries when using import libs.
8558
8559 Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than
8560 @samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number
8561 of names to match each library. All that is needed from the developer's
8562 perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to
8563 select the dll instead of an import library.
8564
8565
8566 For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt
8567 to find, in the first directory of its search path,
8568
8569 @example
8570 libxxx.dll.a
8571 xxx.dll.a
8572 libxxx.a
8573 xxx.lib
8574 libxxx.lib
8575 cygxxx.dll (*)
8576 libxxx.dll
8577 xxx.dll
8578 @end example
8579
8580 before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
8581
8582 (*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll},
8583 where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option
8584 @samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec
8585 file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for
8586 @samp{cygxxx.dll}.
8587
8588 Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other
8589 @samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature. It
8590 was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the
8591 various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
8592 could coexist on the same machine.
8593
8594 The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for
8595 applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import
8596 libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
8597
8598 @example
8599 bin/
8600 cygxxx.dll
8601 lib/
8602 libxxx.dll.a (in case of dll's)
8603 libxxx.a (in case of static archive)
8604 @end example
8605
8606 Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
8607 done two ways:
8608
8609 1. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line
8610 @example
8611 gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
8612 @end example
8613
8614 However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names
8615 (@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies
8616 @samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version. Import libs are generally
8617 not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
8618
8619 2. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib}
8620 directory according to the above mentioned search pattern. This
8621 should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
8622 making the app/dll.
8623
8624 @example
8625 ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
8626 @end example
8627
8628 Then you can link without any make environment changes.
8629
8630 @example
8631 gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
8632 @end example
8633
8634 This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is
8635 perfectly legal
8636
8637 @example
8638 bin/
8639 cygxxx-5.dll
8640 lib/
8641 libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
8642 @end example
8643
8644 Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
8645 even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
8646 @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used.
8647
8648 Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably
8649 wonder why import libraries are used at all. There are three reasons:
8650
8651 1. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not}
8652 work with auto-imported data.
8653
8654 2. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the
8655 import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection
8656 symbols that point to the exports of a dll). Again, the import lib
8657 for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not
8658 possible to do this without an import lib.
8659
8660 3. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib. This is
8661 critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API)
8662 in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their
8663 stdcall-decorated assembly names.
8664
8665 So, import libs are not going away. But the ability to replace
8666 true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of)
8667 a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
8668 binutils makes available to the win32 developer. Given the
8669 massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
8670 requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
8671 will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
8672
8673 @item symbol aliasing
8674 @table @emph
8675 @item adding additional names
8676 Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names.
8677 A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be
8678 exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file
8679 when creating the dll. This will affect also the optional created
8680 import library. Consider the following DEF file:
8681
8682 @example
8683 LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8684
8685 EXPORTS
8686 foo
8687 _foo = foo
8688 @end example
8689
8690 The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}.
8691
8692 Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the
8693 source code using the "weak" attribute:
8694
8695 @example
8696 void foo () @{ /* Do something. */; @}
8697 void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
8698 @end example
8699
8700 See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak
8701 symbols.
8702
8703 @item renaming symbols
8704 Sometimes it is useful to rename exports. For instance, the cygwin
8705 kernel does this regularly. A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as
8706 @samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the
8707 DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is
8708 created). In the following example:
8709
8710 @example
8711 LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8712
8713 EXPORTS
8714 _foo = foo
8715 @end example
8716
8717 The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to
8718 @samp{_foo}.
8719 @end table
8720
8721 Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
8722 unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used.
8723 If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
8724 @emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols
8725 that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the
8726 @samp{--export-all-symbols} option. If you list only the
8727 renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols}
8728 to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and}
8729 the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported.
8730 In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them,
8731 which is probably not what you wanted.
8732
8733 @cindex weak externals
8734 @item weak externals
8735 The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called
8736 weak externals. When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not
8737 defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol. There
8738 are three variants of weak externals:
8739 @itemize
8740 @item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically
8741 called lazy externals.
8742 @item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries.
8743 This form is not presently implemented.
8744 @item No search; the symbol is an alias. This form is not presently
8745 implemented.
8746 @end itemize
8747 As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol
8748 are supported. If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol
8749 uses a default value.
8750
8751 @cindex aligned common symbols
8752 @item aligned common symbols
8753 As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the
8754 desired alignment for a common symbol. This information is conveyed from
8755 the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands
8756 carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized
8757 by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols. Native
8758 tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension,
8759 but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy
8760 warnings about unknown linker directives.
8761
8762 @end table
8763
8764 @ifclear GENERIC
8765 @lowersections
8766 @end ifclear
8767 @end ifset
8768
8769 @ifset XTENSA
8770 @ifclear GENERIC
8771 @raisesections
8772 @end ifclear
8773
8774 @node Xtensa
8775 @section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors
8776
8777 @cindex Xtensa processors
8778 The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
8779 @code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
8780 specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
8781 keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets. For
8782 example, with the command:
8783
8784 @smallexample
8785 SECTIONS
8786 @{
8787 .text : @{
8788 *(.literal .text)
8789 @}
8790 @}
8791 @end smallexample
8792
8793 @noindent
8794 @command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal}
8795 and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the
8796 literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets. A valid
8797 interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial
8798 group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of
8799 files. Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files
8800 and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow.
8801
8802 @cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa
8803 @cindex relaxing on Xtensa
8804 Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and
8805 provides two important link-time optimizations. The first optimization
8806 is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size. A redundant
8807 literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it
8808 will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
8809 location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
8810 the @code{L32R} instructions. The second optimization is to remove
8811 unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of
8812 @code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within
8813 range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions.
8814
8815 For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized
8816 to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}}
8817 instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R}
8818 instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R}
8819 instruction if it is not used for anything else. Removing the
8820 @code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially
8821 hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets.
8822 By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by
8823 switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent
8824 density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R}
8825 instruction that was removed. If code size is more important than
8826 performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the
8827 linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in
8828 a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness.
8829
8830 The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
8831 control the linker:
8832
8833 @cindex Xtensa options
8834 @table @option
8835 @item --size-opt
8836 When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size
8837 more than performance. With this option, the linker will not insert
8838 no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target
8839 alignment. There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to
8840 preserve the correctness of the code.
8841
8842 @item --abi-windowed
8843 @itemx --abi-call0
8844 Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code.
8845 PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object
8846 because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call
8847 conventions.
8848 Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section
8849 of the first input object.
8850 A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other
8851 or the chosen output object ABI.
8852 @end table
8853
8854 @ifclear GENERIC
8855 @lowersections
8856 @end ifclear
8857 @end ifset
8858
8859 @ifclear SingleFormat
8860 @node BFD
8861 @chapter BFD
8862
8863 @cindex back end
8864 @cindex object file management
8865 @cindex object formats available
8866 @kindex objdump -i
8867 The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
8868 These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
8869 object files whatever the object file format. A different object file
8870 format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
8871 it to the library. To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
8872 associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
8873 object file formats available. You can use @code{objdump -i}
8874 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to
8875 list all the formats available for your configuration.
8876
8877 @cindex BFD requirements
8878 @cindex requirements for BFD
8879 As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between
8880 several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing
8881 BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between
8882 formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not
8883 been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since
8884 BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care
8885 may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed.
8886
8887 One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in
8888 mind is the potential for information loss. There are two places where
8889 useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
8890 conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}.
8891
8892 @menu
8893 * BFD outline:: How it works: an outline of BFD
8894 @end menu
8895
8896 @node BFD outline
8897 @section How It Works: An Outline of BFD
8898 @cindex opening object files
8899 @include bfdsumm.texi
8900 @end ifclear
8901
8902 @node Reporting Bugs
8903 @chapter Reporting Bugs
8904 @cindex bugs in @command{ld}
8905 @cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld}
8906
8907 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable.
8908
8909 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or
8910 it may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is
8911 to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld}
8912 work better. Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of
8913 @command{ld}.
8914
8915 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
8916 information that enables us to fix the bug.
8917
8918 @menu
8919 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
8920 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
8921 @end menu
8922
8923 @node Bug Criteria
8924 @section Have You Found a Bug?
8925 @cindex bug criteria
8926
8927 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
8928
8929 @itemize @bullet
8930 @cindex fatal signal
8931 @cindex linker crash
8932 @cindex crash of linker
8933 @item
8934 If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
8935 @command{ld} bug. Reliable linkers never crash.
8936
8937 @cindex error on valid input
8938 @item
8939 If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
8940
8941 @cindex invalid input
8942 @item
8943 If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
8944 may be a bug. In the general case, the linker can not verify that
8945 object files are correct.
8946
8947 @item
8948 If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
8949 improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case.
8950 @end itemize
8951
8952 @node Bug Reporting
8953 @section How to Report Bugs
8954 @cindex bug reports
8955 @cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting
8956
8957 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu}
8958 products. If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we
8959 recommend you contact that organization first.
8960
8961 You can find contact information for many support companies and
8962 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
8963 distribution.
8964
8965 @ifset BUGURL
8966 Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to
8967 @value{BUGURL}.
8968 @end ifset
8969
8970 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
8971 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
8972 fact or leave it out, state it!
8973
8974 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
8975 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
8976 assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not
8977 matter. Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps
8978 the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the
8979 location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name
8980 were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker
8981 into doing the right thing despite the bug. Play it safe and give a
8982 specific, complete example. That is the easiest thing for you to do,
8983 and the most helpful.
8984
8985 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
8986 the bug if it is new to us. Therefore, always write your bug reports
8987 on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
8988
8989 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
8990 bell?'' This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless. We
8991 respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
8992 You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
8993
8994 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
8995
8996 @itemize @bullet
8997 @item
8998 The version of @command{ld}. @command{ld} announces it if you start it with
8999 the @samp{--version} argument.
9000
9001 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
9002 the bug in the current version of @command{ld}.
9003
9004 @item
9005 Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any
9006 patches made to the @code{BFD} library.
9007
9008 @item
9009 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
9010 version number.
9011
9012 @item
9013 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g.
9014 ``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
9015
9016 @item
9017 The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
9018 observe the bug. To guarantee you will not omit something important,
9019 list them all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is
9020 sufficient.
9021
9022 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
9023 and then we might not encounter the bug.
9024
9025 @item
9026 A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the
9027 bug. It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files
9028 provided that they are reasonably small. Say no more than 10K. For
9029 bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else
9030 state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever
9031 requests them. (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so
9032 we do not want to clog it up with large attachments). But small
9033 attachments are best.
9034
9035 If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using
9036 @code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
9037 object files. In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
9038 @code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files. Also say
9039 how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured.
9040
9041 @item
9042 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
9043 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
9044
9045 Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we
9046 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
9047 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
9048 a chance to make a mistake.
9049
9050 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
9051 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
9052 copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the
9053 C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might crash
9054 and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours
9055 fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us. If
9056 you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw
9057 any conclusion from our observations.
9058
9059 @item
9060 If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context
9061 diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or
9062 @samp{-p} option. Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.
9063 If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by
9064 context, not by line number.
9065
9066 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
9067 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
9068 @end itemize
9069
9070 Here are some things that are not necessary:
9071
9072 @itemize @bullet
9073 @item
9074 A description of the envelope of the bug.
9075
9076 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
9077 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
9078 changes will not affect it.
9079
9080 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
9081 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
9082 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
9083 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
9084
9085 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
9086 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
9087 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
9088 less time, and so on.
9089
9090 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
9091 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
9092
9093 @item
9094 A patch for the bug.
9095
9096 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
9097 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
9098 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
9099 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
9100
9101 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to
9102 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
9103 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be
9104 able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is
9105 fixed.
9106
9107 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
9108 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
9109 help us to understand.
9110
9111 @item
9112 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
9113
9114 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
9115 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
9116 @end itemize
9117
9118 @node MRI
9119 @appendix MRI Compatible Script Files
9120 @cindex MRI compatibility
9121 To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI
9122 linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an
9123 alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language
9124 described in @ref{Scripts}. MRI compatible linker scripts have a much
9125 simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with
9126 @command{ld}. @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI
9127 linker commands; these commands are described here.
9128
9129 In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object
9130 file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
9131 features to make use of them.
9132
9133 You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
9134 @samp{-c} command-line option.
9135
9136 Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
9137 command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
9138 blank lines are also allowed for punctuation). If a line of an
9139 MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld}
9140 issues a warning message, but continues processing the script.
9141
9142 Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments.
9143
9144 You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
9145 lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}.
9146 The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
9147
9148 @table @code
9149 @cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI)
9150 @item ABSOLUTE @var{secname}
9151 @itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9152 Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all
9153 the input files. However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the
9154 @code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in
9155 your output program. If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a
9156 script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE}
9157 commands will appear in the linker output. You can still use other
9158 input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using
9159 @code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file.
9160
9161 @cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI)
9162 @item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname}
9163 Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname}
9164 in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file.
9165
9166 @var{in-secname} may be an integer.
9167
9168 @cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI)
9169 @item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression}
9170 Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}. The
9171 @var{expression} should be a power of two.
9172
9173 @cindex @code{BASE} (MRI)
9174 @item BASE @var{expression}
9175 Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than
9176 absolute addresses) in the output file.
9177
9178 @cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI)
9179 @item CHIP @var{expression}
9180 @itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression}
9181 This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
9182
9183 @cindex @code{END} (MRI)
9184 @item END
9185 This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility.
9186
9187 @cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI)
9188 @item FORMAT @var{output-format}
9189 Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker
9190 language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S}
9191
9192 @cindex @code{LIST} (MRI)
9193 @item LIST @var{anything}@dots{}
9194 Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
9195 @command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}.
9196
9197 The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the
9198 same line, with no change in its effect.
9199
9200 @cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI)
9201 @item LOAD @var{filename}
9202 @itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename}
9203 Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the
9204 same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld}
9205 command line.
9206
9207 @cindex @code{NAME} (MRI)
9208 @item NAME @var{output-name}
9209 @var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the
9210 MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line
9211 option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}.
9212
9213 @cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI)
9214 @item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9215 @itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname}
9216 Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the
9217 order in which they first appear in the input files. In an MRI-compatible
9218 script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command. The
9219 sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output
9220 file, in the order specified.
9221
9222 @cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI)
9223 @item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression}
9224 @itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression}
9225 @itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression}
9226 Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol
9227 @var{name} used in the linker input files.
9228
9229 @cindex @code{SECT} (MRI)
9230 @item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression}
9231 @itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression}
9232 @itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression}
9233 You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to
9234 specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}.
9235 If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same
9236 @var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address.
9237 @end table
9238
9239 @node GNU Free Documentation License
9240 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
9241 @include fdl.texi
9242
9243 @node LD Index
9244 @unnumbered LD Index
9245
9246 @printindex cp
9247
9248 @tex
9249 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
9250 % meantime:
9251 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
9252 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
9253 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
9254 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
9255 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
9256 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and}
9257 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
9258 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
9259 \page\colophon
9260 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91.
9261 @end tex
9262
9263 @bye